| /*------------------------------------------------------------------------- |
| * |
| * xlog.c |
| * PostgreSQL write-ahead log manager |
| * |
| * |
| * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2021, PostgreSQL Global Development Group |
| * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California |
| * |
| * src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c |
| * |
| *------------------------------------------------------------------------- |
| */ |
| |
| #include "postgres.h" |
| |
| #include <ctype.h> |
| #include <math.h> |
| #include <time.h> |
| #include <fcntl.h> |
| #include <sys/stat.h> |
| #include <sys/time.h> |
| #include <unistd.h> |
| |
| #include "access/clog.h" |
| #include "access/commit_ts.h" |
| #include "access/heaptoast.h" |
| #include "access/multixact.h" |
| #include "access/rewriteheap.h" |
| #include "access/subtrans.h" |
| #include "access/timeline.h" |
| #include "access/transam.h" |
| #include "access/twophase.h" |
| #include "access/xact.h" |
| #include "access/xlog_internal.h" |
| #include "access/xlogarchive.h" |
| #include "access/xloginsert.h" |
| #include "access/xlogreader.h" |
| #include "access/xlogutils.h" |
| #include "catalog/catversion.h" |
| #include "catalog/pg_control.h" |
| #include "catalog/pg_database.h" |
| #include "commands/progress.h" |
| #include "commands/tablespace.h" |
| #include "common/controldata_utils.h" |
| #include "common/file_utils.h" |
| #include "crypto/kmgr.h" |
| #include "executor/instrument.h" |
| #include "crypto/bufenc.h" |
| #include "miscadmin.h" |
| #include "pg_trace.h" |
| #include "pgstat.h" |
| #include "port/atomics.h" |
| #include "port/pg_iovec.h" |
| #include "postmaster/bgwriter.h" |
| #include "postmaster/postmaster.h" |
| #include "postmaster/startup.h" |
| #include "postmaster/walwriter.h" |
| #include "replication/basebackup.h" |
| #include "replication/logical.h" |
| #include "replication/origin.h" |
| #include "replication/slot.h" |
| #include "replication/snapbuild.h" |
| #include "replication/walreceiver.h" |
| #include "replication/walsender.h" |
| #include "storage/bufmgr.h" |
| #include "storage/fd.h" |
| #include "storage/ipc.h" |
| #include "storage/large_object.h" |
| #include "storage/latch.h" |
| #include "storage/pmsignal.h" |
| #include "storage/predicate.h" |
| #include "storage/proc.h" |
| #include "storage/procarray.h" |
| #include "storage/reinit.h" |
| #include "storage/smgr.h" |
| #include "storage/spin.h" |
| #include "storage/sync.h" |
| #include "utils/builtins.h" |
| #include "utils/guc.h" |
| #include "utils/memutils.h" |
| #include "utils/ps_status.h" |
| #include "utils/relmapper.h" |
| #include "utils/pg_rusage.h" |
| #include "utils/snapmgr.h" |
| #include "utils/timestamp.h" |
| |
| #include "access/distributedlog.h" |
| #include "catalog/catalog.h" |
| #include "catalog/pg_tablespace.h" |
| #include "cdb/cdbtm.h" |
| #include "cdb/cdbvars.h" |
| #include "postmaster/postmaster.h" |
| #include "replication/syncrep.h" |
| #include "storage/sinvaladt.h" |
| #include "utils/faultinjector.h" |
| #include "utils/resscheduler.h" |
| #include "utils/snapmgr.h" |
| #include "utils/syscache.h" |
| |
| extern uint32 bootstrap_data_checksum_version; |
| extern int bootstrap_file_encryption_method; |
| |
| /* Unsupported old recovery command file names (relative to $PGDATA) */ |
| #define RECOVERY_COMMAND_FILE "recovery.conf" |
| #define RECOVERY_COMMAND_DONE "recovery.done" |
| |
| /* User-settable parameters */ |
| int max_wal_size_mb = 1024; /* 1 GB */ |
| int min_wal_size_mb = 80; /* 80 MB */ |
| int wal_keep_size_mb = 0; |
| int XLOGbuffers = -1; |
| int XLogArchiveTimeout = 0; |
| int XLogArchiveMode = ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF; |
| char *XLogArchiveCommand = NULL; |
| bool EnableHotStandby = false; |
| bool EnableHotDR = false; |
| bool fullPageWrites = true; |
| bool wal_log_hints = false; |
| bool wal_compression = false; |
| char *wal_consistency_checking_string = NULL; |
| bool *wal_consistency_checking = NULL; |
| bool wal_init_zero = true; |
| bool wal_recycle = true; |
| bool log_checkpoints = true; |
| int sync_method = DEFAULT_SYNC_METHOD; |
| int wal_level = WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL; |
| int CommitDelay = 0; /* precommit delay in microseconds */ |
| int CommitSiblings = 5; /* # concurrent xacts needed to sleep */ |
| int wal_retrieve_retry_interval = 5000; |
| int max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb = -1; |
| bool track_wal_io_timing = false; |
| /* tde feature enable or not */ |
| int FileEncryptionEnabled = false; |
| |
| /* GPDB specific */ |
| char *gp_pause_on_restore_point_replay = ""; |
| |
| /* |
| * GPDB: Have we reached a specific continuous recovery target? We set this to |
| * true if WAL replay has found a restore point matching the GPDB-specific GUC |
| * gp_pause_on_restore_point_replay and a promotion has been requested. |
| */ |
| static bool reachedContinuousRecoveryTarget = false; |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| bool XLOG_DEBUG = false; |
| #endif |
| |
| int wal_segment_size = DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE; |
| |
| /* |
| * Number of WAL insertion locks to use. A higher value allows more insertions |
| * to happen concurrently, but adds some CPU overhead to flushing the WAL, |
| * which needs to iterate all the locks. |
| */ |
| #define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS 8 |
| |
| /* |
| * Max distance from last checkpoint, before triggering a new xlog-based |
| * checkpoint. |
| */ |
| int CheckPointSegments; |
| |
| /* Estimated distance between checkpoints, in bytes */ |
| static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate = 0; |
| static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * GUC support |
| */ |
| const struct config_enum_entry sync_method_options[] = { |
| {"fsync", SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false}, |
| #ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH |
| {"fsync_writethrough", SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, false}, |
| #endif |
| #ifdef HAVE_FDATASYNC |
| {"fdatasync", SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false}, |
| #endif |
| #ifdef OPEN_SYNC_FLAG |
| {"open_sync", SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, false}, |
| #endif |
| #ifdef OPEN_DATASYNC_FLAG |
| {"open_datasync", SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, false}, |
| #endif |
| {NULL, 0, false} |
| }; |
| |
| |
| /* |
| * Although only "on", "off", and "always" are documented, |
| * we accept all the likely variants of "on" and "off". |
| */ |
| const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[] = { |
| {"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false}, |
| {"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false}, |
| {"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false}, |
| {"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true}, |
| {"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true}, |
| {"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true}, |
| {"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true}, |
| {"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true}, |
| {"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true}, |
| {NULL, 0, false} |
| }; |
| |
| const struct config_enum_entry recovery_target_action_options[] = { |
| {"pause", RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PAUSE, false}, |
| {"promote", RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PROMOTE, false}, |
| {"shutdown", RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_SHUTDOWN, false}, |
| {NULL, 0, false} |
| }; |
| |
| /* |
| * This is used to track how much xlog has been written by this backend, since |
| * start of transaction or last time SyncReplWaitForLSN() was called for this |
| * transaction. Currently, this is used to check if replication lag avoidance |
| * threshold has reached and if its time to wait for replication before moving |
| * forward for this transaction. |
| */ |
| static uint64_t wal_bytes_written = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Statistics for current checkpoint are collected in this global struct. |
| * Because only the checkpointer or a stand-alone backend can perform |
| * checkpoints, this will be unused in normal backends. |
| */ |
| CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats; |
| |
| /* |
| * ThisTimeLineID will be same in all backends --- it identifies current |
| * WAL timeline for the database system. |
| */ |
| TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Are we doing recovery from XLOG? |
| * |
| * This is only ever true in the startup process; it should be read as meaning |
| * "this process is replaying WAL records", rather than "the system is in |
| * recovery mode". It should be examined primarily by functions that need |
| * to act differently when called from a WAL redo function (e.g., to skip WAL |
| * logging). To check whether the system is in recovery regardless of which |
| * process you're running in, use RecoveryInProgress() but only after shared |
| * memory startup and lock initialization. |
| */ |
| bool InRecovery = false; |
| |
| /* Are we in Hot Standby mode? Only valid in startup process, see xlog.h */ |
| HotStandbyState standbyState = STANDBY_DISABLED; |
| |
| static XLogRecPtr LastRec; |
| |
| /* Local copy of WalRcv->flushedUpto */ |
| static XLogRecPtr flushedUpto = 0; |
| static TimeLineID receiveTLI = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * abortedRecPtr is the start pointer of a broken record at end of WAL when |
| * recovery completes; missingContrecPtr is the location of the first |
| * contrecord that went missing. See CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord for |
| * details. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecPtr abortedRecPtr; |
| static XLogRecPtr missingContrecPtr; |
| |
| /* |
| * During recovery, lastFullPageWrites keeps track of full_page_writes that |
| * the replayed WAL records indicate. It's initialized with full_page_writes |
| * that the recovery starting checkpoint record indicates, and then updated |
| * each time XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record is replayed. |
| */ |
| static bool lastFullPageWrites; |
| |
| /* |
| * Local copy of the state tracked by SharedRecoveryState in shared memory, |
| * It is false if SharedRecoveryState is RECOVERY_STATE_DONE. True actually |
| * means "not known, need to check the shared state". |
| */ |
| static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true; |
| |
| /* |
| * Local copy of SharedHotStandbyActive variable. False actually means "not |
| * known, need to check the shared state". |
| */ |
| static bool LocalHotStandbyActive = false; |
| |
| /* |
| * Local copy of SharedPromoteIsTriggered variable. False actually means "not |
| * known, need to check the shared state". |
| */ |
| static bool LocalPromoteIsTriggered = false; |
| |
| /* |
| * Local state for XLogInsertAllowed(): |
| * 1: unconditionally allowed to insert XLOG |
| * 0: unconditionally not allowed to insert XLOG |
| * -1: must check RecoveryInProgress(); disallow until it is false |
| * Most processes start with -1 and transition to 1 after seeing that recovery |
| * is not in progress. But we can also force the value for special cases. |
| * The coding in XLogInsertAllowed() depends on the first two of these states |
| * being numerically the same as bool true and false. |
| */ |
| static int LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1; |
| |
| /* |
| * When ArchiveRecoveryRequested is set, archive recovery was requested, |
| * ie. signal files were present. When InArchiveRecovery is set, we are |
| * currently recovering using offline XLOG archives. These variables are only |
| * valid in the startup process. |
| * |
| * When ArchiveRecoveryRequested is true, but InArchiveRecovery is false, we're |
| * currently performing crash recovery using only XLOG files in pg_wal, but |
| * will switch to using offline XLOG archives as soon as we reach the end of |
| * WAL in pg_wal. |
| */ |
| bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested = false; |
| bool InArchiveRecovery = false; |
| |
| static bool standby_signal_file_found = false; |
| static bool recovery_signal_file_found = false; |
| |
| /* Was the last xlog file restored from archive, or local? */ |
| static bool restoredFromArchive = false; |
| |
| /* Buffers dedicated to consistency checks of size BLCKSZ */ |
| static char *replay_image_masked = NULL; |
| static char *primary_image_masked = NULL; |
| |
| /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for archive recovery */ |
| char *recoveryRestoreCommand = NULL; |
| char *recoveryEndCommand = NULL; |
| char *archiveCleanupCommand = NULL; |
| RecoveryTargetType recoveryTarget = RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET; |
| bool recoveryTargetInclusive = true; |
| int recoveryTargetAction = RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PAUSE; |
| TransactionId recoveryTargetXid; |
| char *recovery_target_time_string; |
| static TimestampTz recoveryTargetTime; |
| const char *recoveryTargetName; |
| XLogRecPtr recoveryTargetLSN; |
| int recovery_min_apply_delay = 0; |
| |
| /* options formerly taken from recovery.conf for XLOG streaming */ |
| bool StandbyModeRequested = false; |
| char *PrimaryConnInfo = NULL; |
| char *PrimarySlotName = NULL; |
| char *PromoteTriggerFile = NULL; |
| bool wal_receiver_create_temp_slot = false; |
| |
| /* are we currently in standby mode? */ |
| bool StandbyMode = false; |
| |
| Startup_hook_type Startup_hook = NULL; |
| |
| ConsistencyCheck_hook_type xlog_check_consistency_hook = NULL; |
| |
| XLOGDropDatabase_hook_type XLOGDropDatabase_hook = NULL; |
| |
| /* |
| * if recoveryStopsBefore/After returns true, it saves information of the stop |
| * point here |
| */ |
| static TransactionId recoveryStopXid; |
| static TimestampTz recoveryStopTime; |
| static XLogRecPtr recoveryStopLSN; |
| static char recoveryStopName[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| static bool recoveryStopAfter; |
| |
| /* |
| * During normal operation, the only timeline we care about is ThisTimeLineID. |
| * During recovery, however, things are more complicated. To simplify life |
| * for rmgr code, we keep ThisTimeLineID set to the "current" timeline as we |
| * scan through the WAL history (that is, it is the line that was active when |
| * the currently-scanned WAL record was generated). We also need these |
| * timeline values: |
| * |
| * recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal: what the user requested, if any |
| * |
| * recoveryTargetTLIRequested: numeric value of requested timeline, if constant |
| * |
| * recoveryTargetTLI: the currently understood target timeline; changes |
| * |
| * expectedTLEs: a list of TimeLineHistoryEntries for recoveryTargetTLI and the timelines of |
| * its known parents, newest first (so recoveryTargetTLI is always the |
| * first list member). Only these TLIs are expected to be seen in the WAL |
| * segments we read, and indeed only these TLIs will be considered as |
| * candidate WAL files to open at all. |
| * |
| * curFileTLI: the TLI appearing in the name of the current input WAL file. |
| * (This is not necessarily the same as ThisTimeLineID, because we could |
| * be scanning data that was copied from an ancestor timeline when the current |
| * file was created.) During a sequential scan we do not allow this value |
| * to decrease. |
| */ |
| RecoveryTargetTimeLineGoal recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal = RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_LATEST; |
| TimeLineID recoveryTargetTLIRequested = 0; |
| TimeLineID recoveryTargetTLI = 0; |
| static List *expectedTLEs; |
| static TimeLineID curFileTLI; |
| |
| /* |
| * ProcLastRecPtr points to the start of the last XLOG record inserted by the |
| * current backend. It is updated for all inserts. XactLastRecEnd points to |
| * end+1 of the last record, and is reset when we end a top-level transaction, |
| * or start a new one; so it can be used to tell if the current transaction has |
| * created any XLOG records. |
| * |
| * While in parallel mode, this may not be fully up to date. When committing, |
| * a transaction can assume this covers all xlog records written either by the |
| * user backend or by any parallel worker which was present at any point during |
| * the transaction. But when aborting, or when still in parallel mode, other |
| * parallel backends may have written WAL records at later LSNs than the value |
| * stored here. The parallel leader advances its own copy, when necessary, |
| * in WaitForParallelWorkersToFinish. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr ProcLastRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| XLogRecPtr XactLastRecEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| XLogRecPtr XactLastCommitEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| |
| /* |
| * RedoRecPtr is this backend's local copy of the REDO record pointer |
| * (which is almost but not quite the same as a pointer to the most recent |
| * CHECKPOINT record). We update this from the shared-memory copy, |
| * XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr, whenever we can safely do so (ie, when we |
| * hold an insertion lock). See XLogInsertRecord for details. We are also |
| * allowed to update from XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr if we hold the info_lck; |
| * see GetRedoRecPtr. A freshly spawned backend obtains the value during |
| * InitXLOGAccess. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; |
| |
| /* |
| * doPageWrites is this backend's local copy of (forcePageWrites || |
| * fullPageWrites). It is used together with RedoRecPtr to decide whether |
| * a full-page image of a page need to be taken. |
| */ |
| static bool doPageWrites; |
| |
| /* Has the recovery code requested a walreceiver wakeup? */ |
| static bool doRequestWalReceiverReply; |
| |
| /* |
| * RedoStartLSN points to the checkpoint's REDO location which is specified |
| * in a backup label file, backup history file or control file. In standby |
| * mode, XLOG streaming usually starts from the position where an invalid |
| * record was found. But if we fail to read even the initial checkpoint |
| * record, we use the REDO location instead of the checkpoint location as |
| * the start position of XLOG streaming. Otherwise we would have to jump |
| * backwards to the REDO location after reading the checkpoint record, |
| * because the REDO record can precede the checkpoint record. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecPtr RedoStartLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| |
| /*---------- |
| * Shared-memory data structures for XLOG control |
| * |
| * LogwrtRqst indicates a byte position that we need to write and/or fsync |
| * the log up to (all records before that point must be written or fsynced). |
| * LogwrtResult indicates the byte positions we have already written/fsynced. |
| * These structs are identical but are declared separately to indicate their |
| * slightly different functions. |
| * |
| * To read XLogCtl->LogwrtResult, you must hold either info_lck or |
| * WALWriteLock. To update it, you need to hold both locks. The point of |
| * this arrangement is that the value can be examined by code that already |
| * holds WALWriteLock without needing to grab info_lck as well. In addition |
| * to the shared variable, each backend has a private copy of LogwrtResult, |
| * which is updated when convenient. |
| * |
| * The request bookkeeping is simpler: there is a shared XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst |
| * (protected by info_lck), but we don't need to cache any copies of it. |
| * |
| * info_lck is only held long enough to read/update the protected variables, |
| * so it's a plain spinlock. The other locks are held longer (potentially |
| * over I/O operations), so we use LWLocks for them. These locks are: |
| * |
| * WALBufMappingLock: must be held to replace a page in the WAL buffer cache. |
| * It is only held while initializing and changing the mapping. If the |
| * contents of the buffer being replaced haven't been written yet, the mapping |
| * lock is released while the write is done, and reacquired afterwards. |
| * |
| * WALWriteLock: must be held to write WAL buffers to disk (XLogWrite or |
| * XLogFlush). |
| * |
| * ControlFileLock: must be held to read/update control file or create |
| * new log file. |
| * |
| *---------- |
| */ |
| |
| typedef struct XLogwrtRqst |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 to write out */ |
| XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 to flush */ |
| } XLogwrtRqst; |
| |
| typedef struct XLogwrtResult |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 written out */ |
| XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 flushed */ |
| } XLogwrtResult; |
| |
| /* |
| * Inserting to WAL is protected by a small fixed number of WAL insertion |
| * locks. To insert to the WAL, you must hold one of the locks - it doesn't |
| * matter which one. To lock out other concurrent insertions, you must hold |
| * of them. Each WAL insertion lock consists of a lightweight lock, plus an |
| * indicator of how far the insertion has progressed (insertingAt). |
| * |
| * The insertingAt values are read when a process wants to flush WAL from |
| * the in-memory buffers to disk, to check that all the insertions to the |
| * region the process is about to write out have finished. You could simply |
| * wait for all currently in-progress insertions to finish, but the |
| * insertingAt indicator allows you to ignore insertions to later in the WAL, |
| * so that you only wait for the insertions that are modifying the buffers |
| * you're about to write out. |
| * |
| * This isn't just an optimization. If all the WAL buffers are dirty, an |
| * inserter that's holding a WAL insert lock might need to evict an old WAL |
| * buffer, which requires flushing the WAL. If it's possible for an inserter |
| * to block on another inserter unnecessarily, deadlock can arise when two |
| * inserters holding a WAL insert lock wait for each other to finish their |
| * insertion. |
| * |
| * Small WAL records that don't cross a page boundary never update the value, |
| * the WAL record is just copied to the page and the lock is released. But |
| * to avoid the deadlock-scenario explained above, the indicator is always |
| * updated before sleeping while holding an insertion lock. |
| * |
| * lastImportantAt contains the LSN of the last important WAL record inserted |
| * using a given lock. This value is used to detect if there has been |
| * important WAL activity since the last time some action, like a checkpoint, |
| * was performed - allowing to not repeat the action if not. The LSN is |
| * updated for all insertions, unless the XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT flag was |
| * set. lastImportantAt is never cleared, only overwritten by the LSN of newer |
| * records. Tracking the WAL activity directly in WALInsertLock has the |
| * advantage of not needing any additional locks to update the value. |
| */ |
| typedef struct |
| { |
| LWLock lock; |
| XLogRecPtr insertingAt; |
| XLogRecPtr lastImportantAt; |
| } WALInsertLock; |
| |
| /* |
| * All the WAL insertion locks are allocated as an array in shared memory. We |
| * force the array stride to be a power of 2, which saves a few cycles in |
| * indexing, but more importantly also ensures that individual slots don't |
| * cross cache line boundaries. (Of course, we have to also ensure that the |
| * array start address is suitably aligned.) |
| */ |
| typedef union WALInsertLockPadded |
| { |
| WALInsertLock l; |
| char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]; |
| } WALInsertLockPadded; |
| |
| /* |
| * State of an exclusive backup, necessary to control concurrent activities |
| * across sessions when working on exclusive backups. |
| * |
| * EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE means that there is no exclusive backup actually |
| * running, to be more precise pg_start_backup() is not being executed for |
| * an exclusive backup and there is no exclusive backup in progress. |
| * EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STARTING means that pg_start_backup() is starting an |
| * exclusive backup. |
| * EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS means that pg_start_backup() has finished |
| * running and an exclusive backup is in progress. pg_stop_backup() is |
| * needed to finish it. |
| * EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STOPPING means that pg_stop_backup() is stopping an |
| * exclusive backup. |
| */ |
| typedef enum ExclusiveBackupState |
| { |
| EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE = 0, |
| EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STARTING, |
| EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS, |
| EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STOPPING |
| } ExclusiveBackupState; |
| |
| /* |
| * Session status of running backup, used for sanity checks in SQL-callable |
| * functions to start and stop backups. |
| */ |
| static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE; |
| |
| /* |
| * Shared state data for WAL insertion. |
| */ |
| typedef struct XLogCtlInsert |
| { |
| slock_t insertpos_lck; /* protects CurrBytePos and PrevBytePos */ |
| |
| /* |
| * CurrBytePos is the end of reserved WAL. The next record will be |
| * inserted at that position. PrevBytePos is the start position of the |
| * previously inserted (or rather, reserved) record - it is copied to the |
| * prev-link of the next record. These are stored as "usable byte |
| * positions" rather than XLogRecPtrs (see XLogBytePosToRecPtr()). |
| */ |
| uint64 CurrBytePos; |
| uint64 PrevBytePos; |
| |
| /* |
| * Make sure the above heavily-contended spinlock and byte positions are |
| * on their own cache line. In particular, the RedoRecPtr and full page |
| * write variables below should be on a different cache line. They are |
| * read on every WAL insertion, but updated rarely, and we don't want |
| * those reads to steal the cache line containing Curr/PrevBytePos. |
| */ |
| char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]; |
| |
| /* |
| * fullPageWrites is the authoritative value used by all backends to |
| * determine whether to write full-page image to WAL. This shared value, |
| * instead of the process-local fullPageWrites, is required because, when |
| * full_page_writes is changed by SIGHUP, we must WAL-log it before it |
| * actually affects WAL-logging by backends. Checkpointer sets at startup |
| * or after SIGHUP. |
| * |
| * To read these fields, you must hold an insertion lock. To modify them, |
| * you must hold ALL the locks. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* current redo point for insertions */ |
| bool forcePageWrites; /* forcing full-page writes for PITR? */ |
| bool fullPageWrites; |
| |
| /* |
| * exclusiveBackupState indicates the state of an exclusive backup (see |
| * comments of ExclusiveBackupState for more details). nonExclusiveBackups |
| * is a counter indicating the number of streaming base backups currently |
| * in progress. forcePageWrites is set to true when either of these is |
| * non-zero. lastBackupStart is the latest checkpoint redo location used |
| * as a starting point for an online backup. |
| */ |
| ExclusiveBackupState exclusiveBackupState; |
| int nonExclusiveBackups; |
| XLogRecPtr lastBackupStart; |
| |
| /* |
| * WAL insertion locks. |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks; |
| } XLogCtlInsert; |
| |
| /* |
| * Total shared-memory state for XLOG. |
| */ |
| typedef struct XLogCtlData |
| { |
| XLogCtlInsert Insert; |
| |
| /* Protected by info_lck: */ |
| XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst; |
| XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* a recent copy of Insert->RedoRecPtr */ |
| FullTransactionId ckptFullXid; /* nextXid of latest checkpoint */ |
| XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN; /* LSN of newest async commit/abort */ |
| XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN; /* oldest LSN needed by any slot */ |
| |
| XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo; /* latest removed/recycled XLOG segment */ |
| |
| /* Fake LSN counter, for unlogged relations. Protected by ulsn_lck. */ |
| XLogRecPtr unloggedLSN; |
| slock_t ulsn_lck; |
| |
| /* Time and LSN of last xlog segment switch. Protected by WALWriteLock. */ |
| pg_time_t lastSegSwitchTime; |
| XLogRecPtr lastSegSwitchLSN; |
| |
| /* |
| * Protected by info_lck and WALWriteLock (you must hold either lock to |
| * read it, but both to update) |
| */ |
| XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult; |
| |
| /* |
| * Latest initialized page in the cache (last byte position + 1). |
| * |
| * To change the identity of a buffer (and InitializedUpTo), you need to |
| * hold WALBufMappingLock. To change the identity of a buffer that's |
| * still dirty, the old page needs to be written out first, and for that |
| * you need WALWriteLock, and you need to ensure that there are no |
| * in-progress insertions to the page by calling |
| * WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(). |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr InitializedUpTo; |
| |
| /* |
| * These values do not change after startup, although the pointed-to pages |
| * and xlblocks values certainly do. xlblocks values are protected by |
| * WALBufMappingLock. |
| */ |
| char *pages; /* buffers for unwritten XLOG pages */ |
| XLogRecPtr *xlblocks; /* 1st byte ptr-s + XLOG_BLCKSZ */ |
| int XLogCacheBlck; /* highest allocated xlog buffer index */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Shared copy of ThisTimeLineID. Does not change after end-of-recovery. |
| * If we created a new timeline when the system was started up, |
| * PrevTimeLineID is the old timeline's ID that we forked off from. |
| * Otherwise it's equal to ThisTimeLineID. |
| */ |
| TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID; |
| TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID; |
| |
| /* |
| * SharedRecoveryState indicates if we're still in crash or archive |
| * recovery. Protected by info_lck. |
| */ |
| RecoveryState SharedRecoveryState; |
| |
| /* |
| * SharedHotStandbyActive indicates if we allow hot standby queries to be |
| * run. Protected by info_lck. |
| */ |
| bool SharedHotStandbyActive; |
| |
| /* |
| * SharedPromoteIsTriggered indicates if a standby promotion has been |
| * triggered. Protected by info_lck. |
| */ |
| bool SharedPromoteIsTriggered; |
| |
| /* |
| * WalWriterSleeping indicates whether the WAL writer is currently in |
| * low-power mode (and hence should be nudged if an async commit occurs). |
| * Protected by info_lck. |
| */ |
| bool WalWriterSleeping; |
| |
| /* |
| * recoveryWakeupLatch is used to wake up the startup process to continue |
| * WAL replay, if it is waiting for WAL to arrive or failover trigger file |
| * to appear. |
| * |
| * Note that the startup process also uses another latch, its procLatch, |
| * to wait for recovery conflict. If we get rid of recoveryWakeupLatch for |
| * signaling the startup process in favor of using its procLatch, which |
| * comports better with possible generic signal handlers using that latch. |
| * But we should not do that because the startup process doesn't assume |
| * that it's waken up by walreceiver process or SIGHUP signal handler |
| * while it's waiting for recovery conflict. The separate latches, |
| * recoveryWakeupLatch and procLatch, should be used for inter-process |
| * communication for WAL replay and recovery conflict, respectively. |
| */ |
| Latch recoveryWakeupLatch; |
| |
| /* |
| * During recovery, we keep a copy of the latest checkpoint record here. |
| * lastCheckPointRecPtr points to start of checkpoint record and |
| * lastCheckPointEndPtr points to end+1 of checkpoint record. Used by the |
| * checkpointer when it wants to create a restartpoint. |
| * |
| * Protected by info_lck. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr; |
| XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr; |
| CheckPoint lastCheckPoint; |
| |
| /* |
| * lastReplayedEndRecPtr points to end+1 of the last record successfully |
| * replayed. When we're currently replaying a record, ie. in a redo |
| * function, replayEndRecPtr points to the end+1 of the record being |
| * replayed, otherwise it's equal to lastReplayedEndRecPtr. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr lastReplayedEndRecPtr; |
| TimeLineID lastReplayedTLI; |
| XLogRecPtr replayEndRecPtr; |
| TimeLineID replayEndTLI; |
| /* timestamp of last COMMIT/ABORT record replayed (or being replayed) */ |
| TimestampTz recoveryLastXTime; |
| |
| /* |
| * timestamp of when we started replaying the current chunk of WAL data, |
| * only relevant for replication or archive recovery |
| */ |
| TimestampTz currentChunkStartTime; |
| /* Recovery pause state */ |
| RecoveryPauseState recoveryPauseState; |
| ConditionVariable recoveryNotPausedCV; |
| |
| /* |
| * lastFpwDisableRecPtr points to the start of the last replayed |
| * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record that instructs full_page_writes is disabled. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr lastFpwDisableRecPtr; |
| |
| slock_t info_lck; /* locks shared variables shown above */ |
| } XLogCtlData; |
| |
| static XLogCtlData *XLogCtl = NULL; |
| |
| /* a private copy of XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks, for convenience */ |
| static WALInsertLockPadded *WALInsertLocks = NULL; |
| |
| /* |
| * We maintain an image of pg_control in shared memory. |
| */ |
| static ControlFileData *ControlFile = NULL; |
| |
| /* |
| * Calculate the amount of space left on the page after 'endptr'. Beware |
| * multiple evaluation! |
| */ |
| #define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr) \ |
| (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ)) |
| |
| /* Macro to advance to next buffer index. */ |
| #define NextBufIdx(idx) \ |
| (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1)) |
| |
| /* |
| * XLogRecPtrToBufIdx returns the index of the WAL buffer that holds, or |
| * would hold if it was in cache, the page containing 'recptr'. |
| */ |
| #define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr) \ |
| (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1)) |
| |
| /* |
| * These are the number of bytes in a WAL page usable for WAL data. |
| */ |
| #define UsableBytesInPage (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD) |
| |
| /* |
| * Convert values of GUCs measured in megabytes to equiv. segment count. |
| * Rounds down. |
| */ |
| #define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize) XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize)) |
| |
| /* The number of bytes in a WAL segment usable for WAL data. */ |
| static int UsableBytesInSegment; |
| |
| /* |
| * Private, possibly out-of-date copy of shared LogwrtResult. |
| * See discussion above. |
| */ |
| static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult = {0, 0}; |
| |
| /* |
| * Codes indicating where we got a WAL file from during recovery, or where |
| * to attempt to get one. |
| */ |
| typedef enum |
| { |
| XLOG_FROM_ANY = 0, /* request to read WAL from any source */ |
| XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE, /* restored using restore_command */ |
| XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL, /* existing file in pg_wal */ |
| XLOG_FROM_STREAM /* streamed from primary */ |
| } XLogSource; |
| |
| /* human-readable names for XLogSources, for debugging output */ |
| static const char *const xlogSourceNames[] = {"any", "archive", "pg_wal", "stream"}; |
| |
| /* |
| * openLogFile is -1 or a kernel FD for an open log file segment. |
| * openLogSegNo identifies the segment. These variables are only used to |
| * write the XLOG, and so will normally refer to the active segment. |
| * Note: call Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of this FD. |
| */ |
| static int openLogFile = -1; |
| static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * These variables are used similarly to the ones above, but for reading |
| * the XLOG. readOff is the offset of the page just read, readLen |
| * indicates how much of it has been read into readBuf, and readSource |
| * indicates where we got the currently open file from. |
| * Note: we could use Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of |
| * this FD too; but it doesn't currently seem worthwhile, since the XLOG is |
| * not read by general-purpose sessions. |
| */ |
| static int readFile = -1; |
| static XLogSegNo readSegNo = 0; |
| static uint32 readOff = 0; |
| static uint32 readLen = 0; |
| static XLogSource readSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY; |
| |
| /* |
| * Keeps track of which source we're currently reading from. This is |
| * different from readSource in that this is always set, even when we don't |
| * currently have a WAL file open. If lastSourceFailed is set, our last |
| * attempt to read from currentSource failed, and we should try another source |
| * next. |
| * |
| * pendingWalRcvRestart is set when a config change occurs that requires a |
| * walreceiver restart. This is only valid in XLOG_FROM_STREAM state. |
| */ |
| static XLogSource currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY; |
| static bool lastSourceFailed = false; |
| static bool pendingWalRcvRestart = false; |
| |
| typedef struct XLogPageReadPrivate |
| { |
| int emode; |
| bool fetching_ckpt; /* are we fetching a checkpoint record? */ |
| bool randAccess; |
| } XLogPageReadPrivate; |
| |
| /* |
| * These variables track when we last obtained some WAL data to process, |
| * and where we got it from. (XLogReceiptSource is initially the same as |
| * readSource, but readSource gets reset to zero when we don't have data |
| * to process right now. It is also different from currentSource, which |
| * also changes when we try to read from a source and fail, while |
| * XLogReceiptSource tracks where we last successfully read some WAL.) |
| */ |
| static TimestampTz XLogReceiptTime = 0; |
| static XLogSource XLogReceiptSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY; |
| |
| /* State information for XLOG reading */ |
| static XLogRecPtr ReadRecPtr; /* start of last record read */ |
| static XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr; /* end+1 of last record read */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Local copies of equivalent fields in the control file. When running |
| * crash recovery, minRecoveryPoint is set to InvalidXLogRecPtr as we |
| * expect to replay all the WAL available, and updateMinRecoveryPoint is |
| * switched to false to prevent any updates while replaying records. |
| * Those values are kept consistent as long as crash recovery runs. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecPtr minRecoveryPoint; |
| static TimeLineID minRecoveryPointTLI; |
| static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true; |
| |
| /* |
| * Have we reached a consistent database state? In crash recovery, we have |
| * to replay all the WAL, so reachedConsistency is never set. During archive |
| * recovery, the database is consistent once minRecoveryPoint is reached. |
| */ |
| bool reachedConsistency = false; |
| |
| static bool InRedo = false; |
| |
| /* Have we launched bgwriter during recovery? */ |
| static bool bgwriterLaunched = false; |
| |
| /* For WALInsertLockAcquire/Release functions */ |
| static int MyLockNo = 0; |
| static bool holdingAllLocks = false; |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| static MemoryContext walDebugCxt = NULL; |
| #endif |
| |
| static void readRecoverySignalFile(void); |
| static void validateRecoveryParameters(void); |
| static void exitArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog); |
| static bool recoveryStopsBefore(XLogReaderState *record); |
| static bool recoveryStopsAfter(XLogReaderState *record); |
| static void ConfirmRecoveryPaused(void); |
| static void recoveryPausesHere(bool endOfRecovery); |
| static bool recoveryApplyDelay(XLogReaderState *record); |
| static void SetLatestXTime(TimestampTz xtime); |
| static void SetCurrentChunkStartTime(TimestampTz xtime); |
| static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void); |
| static void XLogReportParameters(void); |
| static void checkTimeLineSwitch(XLogRecPtr lsn, TimeLineID newTLI, |
| TimeLineID prevTLI); |
| static void VerifyOverwriteContrecord(xl_overwrite_contrecord *xlrec, |
| XLogReaderState *state); |
| static void LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void); |
| static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void); |
| static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn); |
| static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags); |
| static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo); |
| static XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void); |
| |
| static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, bool opportunistic); |
| static bool XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno); |
| static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, bool flexible); |
| static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath, |
| bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, |
| bool use_lock); |
| static int XLogFileRead(XLogSegNo segno, int emode, TimeLineID tli, |
| XLogSource source, bool notfoundOk); |
| static int XLogFileReadAnyTLI(XLogSegNo segno, int emode, XLogSource source); |
| static int XLogPageRead(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, XLogRecPtr targetPagePtr, |
| int reqLen, XLogRecPtr targetRecPtr, char *readBuf); |
| static bool WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable(XLogRecPtr RecPtr, bool randAccess, |
| bool fetching_ckpt, XLogRecPtr tliRecPtr); |
| static int emode_for_corrupt_record(int emode, XLogRecPtr RecPtr); |
| static void XLogFileClose(void); |
| static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr); |
| static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void); |
| static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr); |
| static void RemoveXlogFile(const char *segname, XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, |
| XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo); |
| static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename); |
| static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void); |
| static void CleanupBackupHistory(void); |
| static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force); |
| static XLogRecord *ReadRecord(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, |
| int emode, bool fetching_ckpt); |
| static void CheckRecoveryConsistency(void); |
| static XLogRecord *ReadCheckpointRecord(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, |
| XLogRecPtr RecPtr, int whichChkpt, bool report); |
| static bool rescanLatestTimeLine(void); |
| static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier); |
| static void WriteControlFile(void); |
| static void ReadControlFile(void); |
| static char *str_time(pg_time_t tnow); |
| static void SetPromoteIsTriggered(void); |
| static bool CheckForStandbyTrigger(void); |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| static void xlog_outrec(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record); |
| #endif |
| static void xlog_block_info(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record); |
| static void xlog_outdesc(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record); |
| static void pg_start_backup_callback(int code, Datum arg); |
| static void pg_stop_backup_callback(int code, Datum arg); |
| static bool read_backup_label(XLogRecPtr *checkPointLoc, |
| bool *backupEndRequired, bool *backupFromStandby); |
| static bool read_tablespace_map(List **tablespaces); |
| |
| static void rm_redo_error_callback(void *arg); |
| static int get_sync_bit(int method); |
| |
| /* New functions added for WAL replication */ |
| static void XLogProcessCheckpointRecord(XLogReaderState *rec); |
| static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, |
| XLogRecData *rdata, |
| XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos); |
| static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, |
| XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr); |
| static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, |
| XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr); |
| static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto); |
| static char *GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr); |
| static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos); |
| static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos); |
| static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr); |
| static void checkXLogConsistency(XLogReaderState *record); |
| |
| static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void); |
| static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void); |
| static void WALInsertLockRelease(void); |
| static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt); |
| |
| /* |
| * Insert an XLOG record represented by an already-constructed chain of data |
| * chunks. This is a low-level routine; to construct the WAL record header |
| * and data, use the higher-level routines in xloginsert.c. |
| * |
| * If 'fpw_lsn' is valid, it is the oldest LSN among the pages that this |
| * WAL record applies to, that were not included in the record as full page |
| * images. If fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr, the function does not perform the |
| * insertion and returns InvalidXLogRecPtr. The caller can then recalculate |
| * which pages need a full-page image, and retry. If fpw_lsn is invalid, the |
| * record is always inserted. |
| * |
| * 'flags' gives more in-depth control on the record being inserted. See |
| * XLogSetRecordFlags() for details. |
| * |
| * The first XLogRecData in the chain must be for the record header, and its |
| * data must be MAXALIGNed. XLogInsertRecord fills in the xl_prev and |
| * xl_crc fields in the header, the rest of the header must already be filled |
| * by the caller. |
| * |
| * Returns XLOG pointer to end of record (beginning of next record). |
| * This can be used as LSN for data pages affected by the logged action. |
| * (LSN is the XLOG point up to which the XLOG must be flushed to disk |
| * before the data page can be written out. This implements the basic |
| * WAL rule "write the log before the data".) |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| XLogInsertRecord(XLogRecData *rdata, |
| XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn, |
| uint8 flags, |
| int num_fpi) |
| { |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| pg_crc32c rdata_crc; |
| bool inserted; |
| XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data; |
| uint8 info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK; |
| bool isLogSwitch = (rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID && |
| info == XLOG_SWITCH); |
| XLogRecPtr StartPos; |
| XLogRecPtr EndPos; |
| bool prevDoPageWrites = doPageWrites; |
| |
| /* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */ |
| Assert(rdata->len >= SizeOfXLogRecord); |
| |
| /* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */ |
| if (!XLogInsertAllowed()) |
| elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery"); |
| |
| /*---------- |
| * |
| * We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a |
| * lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL |
| * record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process: |
| * |
| * 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of |
| * reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by |
| * insertpos_lck. |
| * |
| * 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the |
| * correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the |
| * record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes. |
| * |
| * To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent |
| * inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that |
| * an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter |
| * has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks, |
| * determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page |
| * boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has |
| * inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed. |
| * |
| * Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and |
| * fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished. |
| * |
| * Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL |
| * page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to |
| * initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions |
| * to avoid that from happening in the critical path. |
| * |
| *---------- |
| */ |
| START_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| if (isLogSwitch) |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| else |
| WALInsertLockAcquire(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may have |
| * to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can only |
| * happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in this case |
| * and fast otherwise. |
| * |
| * Also check to see if fullPageWrites or forcePageWrites was just turned |
| * on; if we weren't already doing full-page writes then go back and |
| * recompute. |
| * |
| * If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't actually |
| * affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update our local copy |
| * but not force a recomputation. (If doPageWrites was just turned off, |
| * we could recompute the record without full pages, but we choose not to |
| * bother.) |
| */ |
| if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr) |
| { |
| Assert(RedoRecPtr < Insert->RedoRecPtr); |
| RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr; |
| } |
| doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->forcePageWrites); |
| |
| if (doPageWrites && |
| (!prevDoPageWrites || |
| (fpw_lsn != InvalidXLogRecPtr && fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr))) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller didn't |
| * back up. Start over. |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| return InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev |
| * pointer. |
| */ |
| if (isLogSwitch) |
| inserted = ReserveXLogSwitch(&StartPos, &EndPos, &rechdr->xl_prev); |
| else |
| { |
| ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos, |
| &rechdr->xl_prev); |
| inserted = true; |
| } |
| |
| if (inserted) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record |
| * header. |
| */ |
| rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc; |
| COMP_CRC32C(rdata_crc, rechdr, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc)); |
| FIN_CRC32C(rdata_crc); |
| rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc; |
| |
| /* |
| * All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be |
| * inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved. |
| */ |
| CopyXLogRecordToWAL(rechdr->xl_tot_len, isLogSwitch, rdata, |
| StartPos, EndPos); |
| wal_bytes_written += rechdr->xl_tot_len; |
| |
| /* |
| * Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last |
| * important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just |
| * update the first one. |
| */ |
| if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0) |
| { |
| int lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo; |
| |
| WALInsertLocks[lockno].l.lastImportantAt = StartPos; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was |
| * already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need |
| * to do anything. |
| */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Done! Let others know that we're finished. |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| |
| MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny(); |
| |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary. |
| */ |
| if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| /* advance global request to include new block(s) */ |
| if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < EndPos) |
| XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndPos; |
| /* update local result copy while I have the chance */ |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty |
| * padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform |
| * end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver). |
| */ |
| if (isLogSwitch) |
| { |
| TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_SWITCH(); |
| XLogFlush(EndPos); |
| |
| /* |
| * Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is |
| * reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the |
| * xlog-switch record. |
| */ |
| if (inserted) |
| { |
| EndPos = StartPos + SizeOfXLogRecord; |
| if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ) |
| { |
| uint64 offset = XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ) |
| EndPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| else |
| EndPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| if (XLOG_DEBUG) |
| { |
| static XLogReaderState *debug_reader = NULL; |
| StringInfoData buf; |
| StringInfoData recordBuf; |
| char *errormsg = NULL; |
| MemoryContext oldCxt; |
| |
| oldCxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(walDebugCxt); |
| |
| initStringInfo(&buf); |
| appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%X, LSN %X/%X: ", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(StartPos), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPos)); |
| |
| /* |
| * We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData |
| * entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one |
| * contiguous chunk. |
| */ |
| initStringInfo(&recordBuf); |
| for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next) |
| appendBinaryStringInfo(&recordBuf, rdata->data, rdata->len); |
| |
| if (!debug_reader) |
| debug_reader = XLogReaderAllocate(wal_segment_size, NULL, |
| XL_ROUTINE(), NULL); |
| |
| if (!debug_reader) |
| { |
| appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory"); |
| } |
| else if (!DecodeXLogRecord(debug_reader, (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data, |
| &errormsg)) |
| { |
| appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s", |
| errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message"); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - "); |
| xlog_outdesc(&buf, debug_reader); |
| } |
| elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data); |
| |
| pfree(buf.data); |
| pfree(recordBuf.data); |
| MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldCxt); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Update our global variables |
| */ |
| ProcLastRecPtr = StartPos; |
| XactLastRecEnd = EndPos; |
| |
| /* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */ |
| if (inserted) |
| { |
| pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len; |
| pgWalUsage.wal_records++; |
| pgWalUsage.wal_fpi += num_fpi; |
| } |
| |
| return EndPos; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Reserves the right amount of space for a record of given size from the WAL. |
| * *StartPos is set to the beginning of the reserved section, *EndPos to |
| * its end+1. *PrevPtr is set to the beginning of the previous record; it is |
| * used to set the xl_prev of this record. |
| * |
| * This is the performance critical part of XLogInsert that must be serialized |
| * across backends. The rest can happen mostly in parallel. Try to keep this |
| * section as short as possible, insertpos_lck can be heavily contended on a |
| * busy system. |
| * |
| * NB: The space calculation here must match the code in CopyXLogRecordToWAL, |
| * where we actually copy the record to the reserved space. |
| */ |
| static void |
| ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, |
| XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr) |
| { |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| uint64 startbytepos; |
| uint64 endbytepos; |
| uint64 prevbytepos; |
| |
| size = MAXALIGN(size); |
| |
| /* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */ |
| Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord); |
| |
| /* |
| * The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing |
| * the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The |
| * current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position |
| * that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL |
| * page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical |
| * positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and |
| * because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving |
| * X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X". |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck); |
| |
| startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos; |
| endbytepos = startbytepos + size; |
| prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos; |
| Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos; |
| Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos; |
| |
| SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck); |
| |
| *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos); |
| *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos); |
| *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos); |
| |
| /* |
| * Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and |
| * XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions. |
| */ |
| Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos); |
| Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos); |
| Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Like ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), but for an xlog-switch record. |
| * |
| * A log-switch record is handled slightly differently. The rest of the |
| * segment will be reserved for this insertion, as indicated by the returned |
| * *EndPos value. However, if we are already at the beginning of the current |
| * segment, *StartPos and *EndPos are set to the current location without |
| * reserving any space, and the function returns false. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr) |
| { |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| uint64 startbytepos; |
| uint64 endbytepos; |
| uint64 prevbytepos; |
| uint32 size = MAXALIGN(SizeOfXLogRecord); |
| XLogRecPtr ptr; |
| uint32 segleft; |
| |
| /* |
| * These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a |
| * spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there |
| * are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does |
| * compete for it, but that's not called very frequently. |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck); |
| |
| startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos; |
| |
| ptr = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(startbytepos); |
| if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0) |
| { |
| SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck); |
| *EndPos = *StartPos = ptr; |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| endbytepos = startbytepos + size; |
| prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos; |
| |
| *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos); |
| *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos); |
| |
| segleft = wal_segment_size - XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size); |
| if (segleft != wal_segment_size) |
| { |
| /* consume the rest of the segment */ |
| *EndPos += segleft; |
| endbytepos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos); |
| } |
| Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos; |
| Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos; |
| |
| SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck); |
| |
| *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos); |
| |
| Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(*EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0); |
| Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos); |
| Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos); |
| Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos); |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Checks whether the current buffer page and backup page stored in the |
| * WAL record are consistent or not. Before comparing the two pages, a |
| * masking can be applied to the pages to ignore certain areas like hint bits, |
| * unused space between pd_lower and pd_upper among other things. This |
| * function should be called once WAL replay has been completed for a |
| * given record. |
| */ |
| static void |
| checkXLogConsistency(XLogReaderState *record) |
| { |
| RmgrId rmid = XLogRecGetRmid(record); |
| RelFileNode rnode; |
| ForkNumber forknum; |
| BlockNumber blkno; |
| int block_id; |
| |
| /* Records with no backup blocks have no need for consistency checks. */ |
| if (!XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record)) |
| return; |
| |
| Assert((XLogRecGetInfo(record) & XLR_CHECK_CONSISTENCY) != 0); |
| |
| for (block_id = 0; block_id <= record->max_block_id; block_id++) |
| { |
| Buffer buf; |
| Page page; |
| |
| if (!XLogRecGetBlockTag(record, block_id, &rnode, &forknum, &blkno)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * WAL record doesn't contain a block reference with the given id. |
| * Do nothing. |
| */ |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| Assert(XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id)); |
| |
| if (XLogRecBlockImageApply(record, block_id)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * WAL record has already applied the page, so bypass the |
| * consistency check as that would result in comparing the full |
| * page stored in the record with itself. |
| */ |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Read the contents from the current buffer and store it in a |
| * temporary page. |
| */ |
| buf = XLogReadBufferExtended(rnode, forknum, blkno, |
| RBM_NORMAL_NO_LOG); |
| if (!BufferIsValid(buf)) |
| continue; |
| |
| LockBuffer(buf, BUFFER_LOCK_EXCLUSIVE); |
| page = BufferGetPage(buf); |
| |
| /* |
| * Take a copy of the local page where WAL has been applied to have a |
| * comparison base before masking it... |
| */ |
| memcpy(replay_image_masked, page, BLCKSZ); |
| |
| /* No need for this page anymore now that a copy is in. */ |
| UnlockReleaseBuffer(buf); |
| |
| /* |
| * If the block LSN is already ahead of this WAL record, we can't |
| * expect contents to match. This can happen if recovery is |
| * restarted. |
| */ |
| if (PageGetLSN(replay_image_masked) > record->EndRecPtr) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* |
| * Read the contents from the backup copy, stored in WAL record and |
| * store it in a temporary page. There is no need to allocate a new |
| * page here, a local buffer is fine to hold its contents and a mask |
| * can be directly applied on it. |
| */ |
| if (!RestoreBlockImage(record, block_id, primary_image_masked)) |
| elog(ERROR, "failed to restore block image"); |
| |
| /* |
| * If masking function is defined, mask both the primary and replay |
| * images |
| */ |
| if (RmgrTable[rmid].rm_mask != NULL) |
| { |
| RmgrTable[rmid].rm_mask(replay_image_masked, blkno); |
| RmgrTable[rmid].rm_mask(primary_image_masked, blkno); |
| } |
| |
| /* Time to compare the primary and replay images. */ |
| if (memcmp(replay_image_masked, primary_image_masked, BLCKSZ) != 0) |
| { |
| elog(FATAL, |
| "inconsistent page found, rel %u/%u/%u, forknum %u, blkno %u", |
| rnode.spcNode, rnode.dbNode, rnode.relNode, |
| forknum, blkno); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Subroutine of XLogInsertRecord. Copies a WAL record to an already-reserved |
| * area in the WAL. |
| */ |
| static void |
| CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata, |
| XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos) |
| { |
| char *currpos; |
| int freespace; |
| int written; |
| XLogRecPtr CurrPos; |
| XLogPageHeader pagehdr; |
| |
| /* |
| * Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start |
| * inserting to. |
| */ |
| CurrPos = StartPos; |
| currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos); |
| freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos); |
| |
| /* |
| * there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len) |
| * on this page. |
| */ |
| Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32)); |
| |
| /* Copy record data */ |
| written = 0; |
| while (rdata != NULL) |
| { |
| char *rdata_data = rdata->data; |
| int rdata_len = rdata->len; |
| |
| while (rdata_len > freespace) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page. |
| */ |
| Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0); |
| memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace); |
| rdata_data += freespace; |
| rdata_len -= freespace; |
| written += freespace; |
| CurrPos += freespace; |
| |
| /* |
| * Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len |
| * in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD. |
| * |
| * It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a |
| * lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the |
| * page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the |
| * only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag. |
| */ |
| currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos); |
| pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos; |
| pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written; |
| pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD; |
| |
| /* skip over the page header */ |
| if (XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) == 0) |
| { |
| CurrPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| CurrPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD; |
| currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD; |
| } |
| freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos); |
| } |
| |
| Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0); |
| memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len); |
| currpos += rdata_len; |
| CurrPos += rdata_len; |
| freespace -= rdata_len; |
| written += rdata_len; |
| |
| rdata = rdata->next; |
| } |
| Assert(written == write_len); |
| |
| /* |
| * If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record, |
| * we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment. We |
| * have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it. |
| */ |
| if (isLogSwitch && XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) != 0) |
| { |
| /* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */ |
| Assert(write_len == SizeOfXLogRecord); |
| |
| /* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */ |
| Assert(XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size) == 0); |
| |
| /* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */ |
| CurrPos += freespace; |
| |
| /* |
| * Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the |
| * XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment. |
| * We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock |
| * against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size. |
| */ |
| while (CurrPos < EndPos) |
| { |
| /* |
| * The minimal action to flush the page would be to call |
| * WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by |
| * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...). The page would be left initialized |
| * mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short |
| * variant, as this is never a segment's first page). |
| * |
| * The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the |
| * headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that |
| * differ from page to page) are not. The effect varies with |
| * compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an |
| * order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place. |
| * |
| * Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is |
| * called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly- |
| * loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer |
| * (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer |
| * and zero most of the page. Then we just zero the page header. |
| */ |
| currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos); |
| MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD); |
| |
| CurrPos += XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */ |
| CurrPos = MAXALIGN64(CurrPos); |
| } |
| |
| if (CurrPos != EndPos) |
| elog(PANIC, "space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written"); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Acquire a WAL insertion lock, for inserting to WAL. |
| */ |
| static void |
| WALInsertLockAcquire(void) |
| { |
| bool immed; |
| |
| /* |
| * It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try |
| * the one we used last time. If the system isn't particularly busy, it's |
| * a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some |
| * affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce |
| * cache lines between processes when there's no contention. |
| * |
| * If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock |
| * (semi-)randomly. This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a |
| * lot of very short connections. |
| */ |
| static int lockToTry = -1; |
| |
| if (lockToTry == -1) |
| lockToTry = MyProc->pgprocno % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; |
| MyLockNo = lockToTry; |
| |
| /* |
| * The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our |
| * insert location yet. |
| */ |
| immed = LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| if (!immed) |
| { |
| /* |
| * If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next |
| * time. On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent |
| * inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a |
| * lock that no-one else is using. On a system with more inserters |
| * than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly |
| * across the locks. |
| */ |
| lockToTry = (lockToTry + 1) % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Acquire all WAL insertion locks, to prevent other backends from inserting |
| * to WAL. |
| */ |
| static void |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void) |
| { |
| int i; |
| |
| /* |
| * When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt |
| * indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real |
| * XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those. |
| */ |
| for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++) |
| { |
| LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, |
| &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt, |
| PG_UINT64_MAX); |
| } |
| /* Variable value reset to 0 at release */ |
| LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| |
| holdingAllLocks = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Release our insertion lock (or locks, if we're holding them all). |
| * |
| * NB: Reset all variables to 0, so they cause LWLockWaitForVar to block the |
| * next time the lock is acquired. |
| */ |
| static void |
| WALInsertLockRelease(void) |
| { |
| if (holdingAllLocks) |
| { |
| int i; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++) |
| LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, |
| &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt, |
| 0); |
| |
| holdingAllLocks = false; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| LWLockReleaseClearVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock, |
| &WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt, |
| 0); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Update our insertingAt value, to let others know that we've finished |
| * inserting up to that point. |
| */ |
| static void |
| WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt) |
| { |
| if (holdingAllLocks) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in |
| * WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive. |
| */ |
| LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.lock, |
| &WALInsertLocks[NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1].l.insertingAt, |
| insertingAt); |
| } |
| else |
| LWLockUpdateVar(&WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.lock, |
| &WALInsertLocks[MyLockNo].l.insertingAt, |
| insertingAt); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Wait for any WAL insertions < upto to finish. |
| * |
| * Returns the location of the oldest insertion that is still in-progress. |
| * Any WAL prior to that point has been fully copied into WAL buffers, and |
| * can be flushed out to disk. Because this waits for any insertions older |
| * than 'upto' to finish, the return value is always >= 'upto'. |
| * |
| * Note: When you are about to write out WAL, you must call this function |
| * *before* acquiring WALWriteLock, to avoid deadlocks. This function might |
| * need to wait for an insertion to finish (or at least advance to next |
| * uninitialized page), and the inserter might need to evict an old WAL buffer |
| * to make room for a new one, which in turn requires WALWriteLock. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecPtr |
| WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto) |
| { |
| uint64 bytepos; |
| XLogRecPtr reservedUpto; |
| XLogRecPtr finishedUpto; |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| int i; |
| |
| if (MyProc == NULL) |
| elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure"); |
| |
| /* Read the current insert position */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck); |
| bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos; |
| SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck); |
| reservedUpto = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(bytepos); |
| |
| /* |
| * No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been |
| * reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus |
| * LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and |
| * complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean |
| * that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this |
| * corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument. |
| */ |
| if (upto > reservedUpto) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%X, current position %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(upto), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(reservedUpto)))); |
| upto = reservedUpto; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older |
| * than 'upto'. |
| * |
| * finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point up to which all |
| * the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of |
| * reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it |
| * out for any insertion that's still in progress. |
| */ |
| finishedUpto = reservedUpto; |
| for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| |
| do |
| { |
| /* |
| * See if this insertion is in progress. LWLockWaitForVar will |
| * wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set |
| * by a LWLockUpdateVar call. When a lock is initially acquired, |
| * its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't |
| * know where it's inserting yet. We will have to wait for it. If |
| * it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the |
| * same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever |
| * calling LWLockUpdateVar. But if it has to sleep, it will |
| * advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before |
| * sleeping. |
| */ |
| if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, |
| &WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt, |
| insertingat, &insertingat)) |
| { |
| /* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */ |
| insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the |
| * inserter has proceeded past 'upto'. |
| */ |
| } while (insertingat < upto); |
| |
| if (insertingat != InvalidXLogRecPtr && insertingat < finishedUpto) |
| finishedUpto = insertingat; |
| } |
| return finishedUpto; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get a pointer to the right location in the WAL buffer containing the |
| * given XLogRecPtr. |
| * |
| * If the page is not initialized yet, it is initialized. That might require |
| * evicting an old dirty buffer from the buffer cache, which means I/O. |
| * |
| * The caller must ensure that the page containing the requested location |
| * isn't evicted yet, and won't be evicted. The way to ensure that is to |
| * hold onto a WAL insertion lock with the insertingAt position set to |
| * something <= ptr. GetXLogBuffer() will update insertingAt if it needs |
| * to evict an old page from the buffer. (This means that once you call |
| * GetXLogBuffer() with a given 'ptr', you must not access anything before |
| * that point anymore, and must not call GetXLogBuffer() with an older 'ptr' |
| * later, because older buffers might be recycled already) |
| */ |
| static char * |
| GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr) |
| { |
| int idx; |
| XLogRecPtr endptr; |
| static uint64 cachedPage = 0; |
| static char *cachedPos = NULL; |
| XLogRecPtr expectedEndPtr; |
| |
| /* |
| * Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same |
| * page as last time. |
| */ |
| if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage) |
| { |
| Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC); |
| Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ)); |
| return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a |
| * particular buffer. That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given |
| * page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone. |
| */ |
| idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr); |
| |
| /* |
| * See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the |
| * page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer |
| * - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written |
| * out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure |
| * that doesn't happen. |
| * |
| * However, we don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone has |
| * just initialized the page, it's possible that we get a "torn read" of |
| * the XLogRecPtr if 64-bit fetches are not atomic on this platform. In |
| * that case we will see a bogus value. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping |
| * lock (in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything else than |
| * the page we're looking for. But it means that when we do this unlocked |
| * read, we might see a value that appears to be ahead of the page we're |
| * looking for. Don't PANIC on that, until we've verified the value while |
| * holding the lock. |
| */ |
| expectedEndPtr = ptr; |
| expectedEndPtr += XLOG_BLCKSZ - ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| endptr = XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]; |
| if (expectedEndPtr != endptr) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr initializedUpto; |
| |
| /* |
| * Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others |
| * know how far we're finished with inserting the record. |
| * |
| * NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a |
| * position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If |
| * there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush |
| * up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after |
| * the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even |
| * though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first |
| * inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making |
| * sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past |
| * the page header. |
| */ |
| if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD && |
| XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) > XLOG_BLCKSZ) |
| initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogShortPHD; |
| else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD && |
| XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) < XLOG_BLCKSZ) |
| initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| else |
| initializedUpto = ptr; |
| |
| WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(initializedUpto); |
| |
| AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, false); |
| endptr = XLogCtl->xlblocks[idx]; |
| |
| if (expectedEndPtr != endptr) |
| elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ptr)); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and |
| * won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page. |
| */ |
| pg_memory_barrier(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right |
| * offset within the page. |
| */ |
| cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| cachedPos = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC); |
| Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ)); |
| |
| return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Converts a "usable byte position" to XLogRecPtr. A usable byte position |
| * is the position starting from the beginning of WAL, excluding all WAL |
| * page headers. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecPtr |
| XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos) |
| { |
| uint64 fullsegs; |
| uint64 fullpages; |
| uint64 bytesleft; |
| uint32 seg_offset; |
| XLogRecPtr result; |
| |
| fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment; |
| bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment; |
| |
| if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) |
| { |
| /* fits on first page of segment */ |
| seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* account for the first page on segment with long header */ |
| seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| |
| fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage; |
| bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage; |
| |
| seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD; |
| } |
| |
| XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result); |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Like XLogBytePosToRecPtr, but if the position is at a page boundary, |
| * returns a pointer to the beginning of the page (ie. before page header), |
| * not to where the first xlog record on that page would go to. This is used |
| * when converting a pointer to the end of a record. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecPtr |
| XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos) |
| { |
| uint64 fullsegs; |
| uint64 fullpages; |
| uint64 bytesleft; |
| uint32 seg_offset; |
| XLogRecPtr result; |
| |
| fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment; |
| bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment; |
| |
| if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) |
| { |
| /* fits on first page of segment */ |
| if (bytesleft == 0) |
| seg_offset = 0; |
| else |
| seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* account for the first page on segment with long header */ |
| seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| |
| fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage; |
| bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage; |
| |
| if (bytesleft == 0) |
| seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft; |
| else |
| seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD; |
| } |
| |
| XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result); |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Convert an XLogRecPtr to a "usable byte position". |
| */ |
| static uint64 |
| XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr) |
| { |
| uint64 fullsegs; |
| uint32 fullpages; |
| uint32 offset; |
| uint64 result; |
| |
| XLByteToSeg(ptr, fullsegs, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| fullpages = (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size)) / XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| if (fullpages == 0) |
| { |
| result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment; |
| if (offset > 0) |
| { |
| Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD); |
| result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment + |
| (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */ |
| (fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage; /* full pages */ |
| if (offset > 0) |
| { |
| Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD); |
| result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize XLOG buffers, writing out old buffers if they still contain |
| * unwritten data, up to the page containing 'upto'. Or if 'opportunistic' is |
| * true, initialize as many pages as we can without having to write out |
| * unwritten data. Any new pages are initialized to zeros, with pages headers |
| * initialized properly. |
| */ |
| static void |
| AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, bool opportunistic) |
| { |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| int nextidx; |
| XLogRecPtr OldPageRqstPtr; |
| XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst; |
| XLogRecPtr NewPageEndPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| XLogRecPtr NewPageBeginPtr; |
| XLogPageHeader NewPage; |
| int npages = 0; |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| |
| /* |
| * Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page |
| * already. |
| */ |
| while (upto >= XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo || opportunistic) |
| { |
| nextidx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo); |
| |
| /* |
| * Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may |
| * be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet). Fall through if it's |
| * already written out. |
| */ |
| OldPageRqstPtr = XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx]; |
| if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much |
| * as we can without flushing, give up now. |
| */ |
| if (opportunistic) |
| break; |
| |
| /* Before waiting, get info_lck and update LogwrtResult */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < OldPageRqstPtr) |
| XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr; |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * Now that we have an up-to-date LogwrtResult value, see if we |
| * still need to write it or if someone else already did. |
| */ |
| if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first, |
| * to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for |
| * can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk |
| * deadlock. |
| */ |
| LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock); |
| |
| WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(OldPageRqstPtr); |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| if (LogwrtResult.Write >= OldPageRqstPtr) |
| { |
| /* OK, someone wrote it already */ |
| LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Have to write it ourselves */ |
| TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_START(); |
| WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr; |
| WriteRqst.Flush = 0; |
| XLogWrite(WriteRqst, false); |
| LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock); |
| WalStats.m_wal_buffers_full++; |
| TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_DONE(); |
| } |
| /* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */ |
| LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| continue; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the |
| * next output page. |
| */ |
| NewPageBeginPtr = XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo; |
| NewPageEndPtr = NewPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| Assert(XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(NewPageBeginPtr) == nextidx); |
| |
| NewPage = (XLogPageHeader) (XLogCtl->pages + nextidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ); |
| |
| /* |
| * Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've |
| * written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records... |
| */ |
| MemSet((char *) NewPage, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ); |
| |
| /* |
| * Fill the new page's header |
| */ |
| NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC; |
| |
| /* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */ |
| NewPage->xlp_tli = ThisTimeLineID; |
| NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr; |
| |
| /* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */ /* done by memset */ |
| |
| /* |
| * If online backup is not in progress, mark the header to indicate |
| * that WAL records beginning in this page have removable backup |
| * blocks. This allows the WAL archiver to know whether it is safe to |
| * compress archived WAL data by transforming full-block records into |
| * the non-full-block format. It is sufficient to record this at the |
| * page level because we force a page switch (in fact a segment |
| * switch) when starting a backup, so the flag will be off before any |
| * records can be written during the backup. At the end of a backup, |
| * the last page will be marked as all unsafe when perhaps only part |
| * is unsafe, but at worst the archiver would miss the opportunity to |
| * compress a few records. |
| */ |
| if (!Insert->forcePageWrites) |
| NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE; |
| |
| /* |
| * If a record was found to be broken at the end of recovery, and |
| * we're going to write on the page where its first contrecord was |
| * lost, set the XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD flag on the page |
| * header. See CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(). |
| */ |
| if (missingContrecPtr == NewPageBeginPtr) |
| { |
| NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD; |
| missingContrecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header. |
| */ |
| if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0) |
| { |
| XLogLongPageHeader NewLongPage = (XLogLongPageHeader) NewPage; |
| |
| NewLongPage->xlp_sysid = ControlFile->system_identifier; |
| NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size; |
| NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others |
| * before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without |
| * holding a lock. |
| */ |
| pg_write_barrier(); |
| |
| *((volatile XLogRecPtr *) &XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx]) = NewPageEndPtr; |
| |
| XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = NewPageEndPtr; |
| |
| npages++; |
| } |
| LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock); |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0) |
| { |
| elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%X", |
| npages, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(NewPageEndPtr)); |
| } |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Calculate CheckPointSegments based on max_wal_size_mb and |
| * checkpoint_completion_target. |
| */ |
| static void |
| CalculateCheckpointSegments(void) |
| { |
| double target; |
| |
| /*------- |
| * Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid |
| * exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions: |
| * |
| * a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept |
| * WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the |
| * secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we |
| * only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just |
| * one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in |
| * many smaller databases.) |
| * b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target * |
| * number of segments consumed between checkpoints. |
| *------- |
| */ |
| target = (double) ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) / |
| (1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget); |
| |
| /* round down */ |
| CheckPointSegments = (int) target; |
| |
| if (CheckPointSegments < 2) |
| CheckPointSegments = 2; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| assign_max_wal_size(int newval, void *extra) |
| { |
| max_wal_size_mb = newval; |
| CalculateCheckpointSegments(); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| assign_checkpoint_completion_target(double newval, void *extra) |
| { |
| CheckPointCompletionTarget = newval; |
| CalculateCheckpointSegments(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * At a checkpoint, how many WAL segments to recycle as preallocated future |
| * XLOG segments? Returns the highest segment that should be preallocated. |
| */ |
| static XLogSegNo |
| XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr) |
| { |
| XLogSegNo minSegNo; |
| XLogSegNo maxSegNo; |
| double distance; |
| XLogSegNo recycleSegNo; |
| |
| /* |
| * Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb |
| * correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and |
| * remove enough segments to stay below the maximum. |
| */ |
| minSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size + |
| ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1; |
| maxSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size + |
| ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) - 1; |
| |
| /* |
| * Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the |
| * estimated end of next checkpoint. |
| * |
| * To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the |
| * system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between |
| * every checkpoint. |
| */ |
| distance = (1.0 + CheckPointCompletionTarget) * CheckPointDistanceEstimate; |
| /* add 10% for good measure. */ |
| distance *= 1.10; |
| |
| recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) / |
| wal_segment_size); |
| |
| if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo) |
| recycleSegNo = minSegNo; |
| if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo) |
| recycleSegNo = maxSegNo; |
| |
| return recycleSegNo; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check whether we've consumed enough xlog space that a checkpoint is needed. |
| * |
| * new_segno indicates a log file that has just been filled up (or read |
| * during recovery). We measure the distance from RedoRecPtr to new_segno |
| * and see if that exceeds CheckPointSegments. |
| * |
| * Note: it is caller's responsibility that RedoRecPtr is up-to-date. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno) |
| { |
| XLogSegNo old_segno; |
| |
| XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, old_segno, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| if (new_segno >= old_segno + (uint64) (CheckPointSegments - 1)) |
| return true; |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Write and/or fsync the log at least as far as WriteRqst indicates. |
| * |
| * If flexible == true, we don't have to write as far as WriteRqst, but |
| * may stop at any convenient boundary (such as a cache or logfile boundary). |
| * This option allows us to avoid uselessly issuing multiple writes when a |
| * single one would do. |
| * |
| * Must be called with WALWriteLock held. WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst) |
| * must be called before grabbing the lock, to make sure the data is ready to |
| * write. |
| */ |
| static void |
| XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, bool flexible) |
| { |
| bool ispartialpage; |
| bool last_iteration; |
| bool finishing_seg; |
| bool use_existent; |
| int curridx; |
| int npages; |
| int startidx; |
| uint32 startoffset; |
| |
| /* We should always be inside a critical section here */ |
| Assert(CritSectionCount > 0); |
| |
| /* |
| * Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...) |
| */ |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| |
| /* |
| * Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated, |
| * we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one |
| * write() call. npages is the number of pages we have determined can be |
| * written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one, |
| * and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter |
| * two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize |
| * all of them to keep the compiler quiet. |
| */ |
| npages = 0; |
| startidx = 0; |
| startoffset = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to |
| * consider writing. Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten |
| * page, or last partially written page. |
| */ |
| curridx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(LogwrtResult.Write); |
| |
| while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process. This could happen |
| * if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the |
| * last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr EndPtr = XLogCtl->xlblocks[curridx]; |
| |
| if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr) |
| elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%X is past end of log %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write), |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPtr)); |
| |
| /* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */ |
| LogwrtResult.Write = EndPtr; |
| ispartialpage = WriteRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write; |
| |
| if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo, |
| wal_segment_size)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Switch to new logfile segment. We cannot have any pending |
| * pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end). |
| */ |
| Assert(npages == 0); |
| if (openLogFile >= 0) |
| XLogFileClose(); |
| XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* create/use new log file */ |
| use_existent = true; |
| openLogFile = XLogFileInit(openLogSegNo, &use_existent, true); |
| ReserveExternalFD(); |
| } |
| |
| /* Make sure we have the current logfile open */ |
| if (openLogFile < 0) |
| { |
| XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo); |
| ReserveExternalFD(); |
| } |
| |
| /* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */ |
| if (npages == 0) |
| { |
| /* first of group */ |
| startidx = curridx; |
| startoffset = XLogSegmentOffset(LogwrtResult.Write - XLOG_BLCKSZ, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| } |
| npages++; |
| |
| /* |
| * Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are |
| * at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be |
| * contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile |
| * segment. |
| */ |
| last_iteration = WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Write; |
| |
| finishing_seg = !ispartialpage && |
| (startoffset + npages * XLOG_BLCKSZ) >= wal_segment_size; |
| |
| if (last_iteration || |
| curridx == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck || |
| finishing_seg) |
| { |
| char *from; |
| Size nbytes; |
| Size nleft; |
| int written; |
| instr_time start; |
| |
| /* OK to write the page(s) */ |
| from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| nleft = nbytes; |
| do |
| { |
| errno = 0; |
| |
| /* Measure I/O timing to write WAL data */ |
| if (track_wal_io_timing) |
| INSTR_TIME_SET_CURRENT(start); |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_WRITE); |
| written = pg_pwrite(openLogFile, from, nleft, startoffset); |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Increment the I/O timing and the number of times WAL data |
| * were written out to disk. |
| */ |
| if (track_wal_io_timing) |
| { |
| instr_time duration; |
| |
| INSTR_TIME_SET_CURRENT(duration); |
| INSTR_TIME_SUBTRACT(duration, start); |
| WalStats.m_wal_write_time += INSTR_TIME_GET_MICROSEC(duration); |
| } |
| |
| WalStats.m_wal_write++; |
| |
| if (written <= 0) |
| { |
| char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| int save_errno; |
| |
| if (errno == EINTR) |
| continue; |
| |
| save_errno = errno; |
| XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, openLogSegNo, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| errno = save_errno; |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not write to log file %s " |
| "at offset %u, length %zu: %m", |
| xlogfname, startoffset, nleft))); |
| } |
| nleft -= written; |
| from += written; |
| startoffset += written; |
| } while (nleft > 0); |
| |
| npages = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment, |
| * fsync the segment immediately. This avoids having to go back |
| * and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along |
| * later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will |
| * perform this fsync. |
| * |
| * This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the |
| * segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the |
| * timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if |
| * too many logfile segments have been used since the last |
| * checkpoint. |
| */ |
| if (finishing_seg) |
| { |
| issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo); |
| |
| /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */ |
| WalSndWakeupRequest(); |
| |
| LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write; /* end of page */ |
| |
| if (XLogArchivingActive()) |
| XLogArchiveNotifySeg(openLogSegNo); |
| |
| XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = LogwrtResult.Flush; |
| |
| /* |
| * Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since |
| * the last one. For speed, we first check using the local |
| * copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks |
| * like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and |
| * recheck. |
| */ |
| if (IsUnderPostmaster && XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo)) |
| { |
| (void) GetRedoRecPtr(); |
| if (XLogCheckpointNeeded(openLogSegNo)) |
| RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (ispartialpage) |
| { |
| /* Only asked to write a partial page */ |
| LogwrtResult.Write = WriteRqst.Write; |
| break; |
| } |
| curridx = NextBufIdx(curridx); |
| |
| /* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */ |
| if (flexible && npages == 0) |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| Assert(npages == 0); |
| |
| /* |
| * If asked to flush, do so |
| */ |
| if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush && |
| LogwrtResult.Flush < LogwrtResult.Write) |
| |
| { |
| /* |
| * Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might |
| * have no open file or the wrong one. However, we do not need to |
| * fsync more than one file. |
| */ |
| if (sync_method != SYNC_METHOD_OPEN && |
| sync_method != SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC) |
| { |
| if (openLogFile >= 0 && |
| !XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo, |
| wal_segment_size)) |
| XLogFileClose(); |
| if (openLogFile < 0) |
| { |
| XLByteToPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| openLogFile = XLogFileOpen(openLogSegNo); |
| ReserveExternalFD(); |
| } |
| |
| issue_xlog_fsync(openLogFile, openLogSegNo); |
| } |
| |
| /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */ |
| WalSndWakeupRequest(); |
| |
| LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Update shared-memory status |
| * |
| * We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the |
| * 'result' values. This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some |
| * code in a couple of places. |
| */ |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->LogwrtResult = LogwrtResult; |
| if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write) |
| XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = LogwrtResult.Write; |
| if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush < LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = LogwrtResult.Flush; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Record the LSN for an asynchronous transaction commit/abort |
| * and nudge the WALWriter if there is work for it to do. |
| * (This should not be called for synchronous commits.) |
| */ |
| void |
| XLogSetAsyncXactLSN(XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN; |
| bool sleeping; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| sleeping = XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping; |
| if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN) |
| XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * If the WALWriter is sleeping, we should kick it to make it come out of |
| * low-power mode. Otherwise, determine whether there's a full page of |
| * WAL available to write. |
| */ |
| if (!sleeping) |
| { |
| /* back off to last completed page boundary */ |
| WriteRqstPtr -= WriteRqstPtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| /* if we have already flushed that far, we're done */ |
| if (WriteRqstPtr <= LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Nudge the WALWriter: it has a full page of WAL to write, or we want it |
| * to come out of low-power mode so that this async commit will reach disk |
| * within the expected amount of time. |
| */ |
| if (ProcGlobal->walwriterLatch) |
| SetLatch(ProcGlobal->walwriterLatch); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Record the LSN up to which we can remove WAL because it's not required by |
| * any replication slot. |
| */ |
| void |
| XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(XLogRecPtr lsn) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN = lsn; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the oldest LSN we must retain to satisfy the needs of some |
| * replication slot. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecPtr |
| XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr retval; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| retval = XLogCtl->replicationSlotMinLSN; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Advance minRecoveryPoint in control file. |
| * |
| * If we crash during recovery, we must reach this point again before the |
| * database is consistent. |
| * |
| * If 'force' is true, 'lsn' argument is ignored. Otherwise, minRecoveryPoint |
| * is only updated if it's not already greater than or equal to 'lsn'. |
| */ |
| static void |
| UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force) |
| { |
| /* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */ |
| if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= minRecoveryPoint)) |
| return; |
| |
| /* |
| * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL, |
| * i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control file's |
| * value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The |
| * local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be |
| * updated until crash recovery finishes. We only do this for the startup |
| * process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint |
| * until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL |
| * available is replayed in this case. This also saves from extra locks |
| * taken on the control file from the startup process. |
| */ |
| if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery) |
| { |
| updateMinRecoveryPoint = false; |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| |
| /* update local copy */ |
| minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint; |
| minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI; |
| |
| if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint)) |
| updateMinRecoveryPoint = false; |
| else if (force || minRecoveryPoint < lsn) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr newMinRecoveryPoint; |
| TimeLineID newMinRecoveryPointTLI; |
| |
| /* |
| * To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it |
| * all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn' |
| * would suffice for correctness. This also allows the 'force' case |
| * to not need a valid 'lsn' value. |
| * |
| * Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed |
| * 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if |
| * the caller got it from a corrupted heap page. Accepting such a |
| * value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at |
| * all. Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery. |
| * (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.) |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| newMinRecoveryPoint = XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr; |
| newMinRecoveryPointTLI = XLogCtl->replayEndTLI; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn) |
| elog(WARNING, |
| "xlog min recovery request %X/%X is past current point %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(newMinRecoveryPoint)); |
| |
| /* update control file */ |
| if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < newMinRecoveryPoint) |
| { |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint; |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI; |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| minRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint; |
| minRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI; |
| |
| ereport(DEBUG2, |
| (errmsg_internal("updated min recovery point to %X/%X on timeline %u", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(minRecoveryPoint), |
| newMinRecoveryPointTLI))); |
| } |
| } |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Ensure that all XLOG data through the given position is flushed to disk. |
| * |
| * NOTE: this differs from XLogWrite mainly in that the WALWriteLock is not |
| * already held, and we try to avoid acquiring it if possible. |
| */ |
| void |
| XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr; |
| XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst; |
| |
| /* |
| * During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL. Therefore, instead of |
| * trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We |
| * test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer |
| * to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the |
| * end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush. |
| */ |
| if (!XLogInsertAllowed()) |
| { |
| UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Quick exit if already known flushed */ |
| if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| return; |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| if (XLOG_DEBUG) |
| elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%X; write %X/%X; flush %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record), |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write), |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush)); |
| #endif |
| |
| START_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to |
| * piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data |
| * entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that |
| * the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This |
| * gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after. |
| */ |
| |
| /* initialize to given target; may increase below */ |
| WriteRqstPtr = record; |
| |
| /* |
| * Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush |
| * for us. |
| */ |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr insertpos; |
| |
| /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write) |
| WriteRqstPtr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write; |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* done already? */ |
| if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| break; |
| |
| /* |
| * Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight |
| * insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish. |
| */ |
| insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqstPtr); |
| |
| /* |
| * Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait |
| * until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush |
| * or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This |
| * helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system |
| * is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing. |
| */ |
| if (!LWLockAcquireOrWait(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we |
| * do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for |
| * us already. |
| */ |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */ |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| { |
| LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further |
| * backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit |
| * followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput, |
| * at the risk of increasing transaction latency. |
| * |
| * We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are |
| * fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions. |
| */ |
| if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync && |
| MinimumActiveBackends(CommitSiblings)) |
| { |
| pg_usleep(CommitDelay); |
| |
| /* |
| * Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not |
| * safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding |
| * WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to |
| * also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all |
| * the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because |
| * that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned. |
| * We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved |
| * further forward, not to actually wait for anyone. |
| */ |
| insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(insertpos); |
| } |
| |
| /* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */ |
| WriteRqst.Write = insertpos; |
| WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos; |
| |
| XLogWrite(WriteRqst, false); |
| |
| LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock); |
| /* done */ |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */ |
| WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a |
| * problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG. |
| * This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN. |
| * |
| * Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the |
| * system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down |
| * the whole system due to corruption on one data page. In particular, if |
| * the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be |
| * unable to restart the database at all! (This scenario actually |
| * happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.) As of 8.4, bad |
| * LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem; |
| * the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the |
| * end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a |
| * bad LSN. |
| * |
| * Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC |
| * since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section. However, |
| * calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not |
| * force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page. |
| */ |
| if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record) |
| elog(ERROR, |
| "xlog flush request %X/%X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record), |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush)); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Write & flush xlog, but without specifying exactly where to. |
| * |
| * We normally write only completed blocks; but if there is nothing to do on |
| * that basis, we check for unwritten async commits in the current incomplete |
| * block, and write through the latest one of those. Thus, if async commits |
| * are not being used, we will write complete blocks only. |
| * |
| * If, based on the above, there's anything to write we do so immediately. But |
| * to avoid calling fsync, fdatasync et. al. at a rate that'd impact |
| * concurrent IO, we only flush WAL every wal_writer_delay ms, or if there's |
| * more than wal_writer_flush_after unflushed blocks. |
| * |
| * We can guarantee that async commits reach disk after at most three |
| * wal_writer_delay cycles. (When flushing complete blocks, we allow XLogWrite |
| * to write "flexibly", meaning it can stop at the end of the buffer ring; |
| * this makes a difference only with very high load or long wal_writer_delay, |
| * but imposes one extra cycle for the worst case for async commits.) |
| * |
| * This routine is invoked periodically by the background walwriter process. |
| * |
| * Returns true if there was any work to do, even if we skipped flushing due |
| * to wal_writer_delay/wal_writer_flush_after. |
| */ |
| bool |
| XLogBackgroundFlush(void) |
| { |
| XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst; |
| bool flexible = true; |
| static TimestampTz lastflush; |
| TimestampTz now; |
| int flushbytes; |
| |
| /* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */ |
| if (RecoveryInProgress()) |
| return false; |
| |
| /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| WriteRqst = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* back off to last completed page boundary */ |
| WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| /* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */ |
| if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| WriteRqst.Write = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| flexible = false; /* ensure it all gets written */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are |
| * holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use, |
| * preventing the file from being deleted. |
| */ |
| if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| { |
| if (openLogFile >= 0) |
| { |
| if (!XLByteInPrevSeg(LogwrtResult.Write, openLogSegNo, |
| wal_segment_size)) |
| { |
| XLogFileClose(); |
| } |
| } |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and |
| * wal_writer_flush_after GUCs. |
| */ |
| now = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| flushbytes = |
| WriteRqst.Write / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0) |
| { |
| /* first call, or block based limits disabled */ |
| WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write; |
| lastflush = now; |
| } |
| else if (TimestampDifferenceExceeds(lastflush, now, WalWriterDelay)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is |
| * important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous |
| * commit to hit disk. |
| */ |
| WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write; |
| lastflush = now; |
| } |
| else if (flushbytes >= WalWriterFlushAfter) |
| { |
| /* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */ |
| WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write; |
| lastflush = now; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* no flushing, this time round */ |
| WriteRqst.Flush = 0; |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| if (XLOG_DEBUG) |
| elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%X; flush: %X/%X, current is write %X/%X; flush %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Write), |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Flush), |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Write), |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(LogwrtResult.Flush)); |
| #endif |
| |
| START_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| /* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */ |
| WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst.Write); |
| LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write || |
| WriteRqst.Flush > LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| { |
| XLogWrite(WriteRqst, flexible); |
| } |
| LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock); |
| |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */ |
| WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize |
| * as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can. |
| */ |
| AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else |
| * wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to |
| * avoid hibernating too early. |
| */ |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Test whether XLOG data has been flushed up to (at least) the given position. |
| * |
| * Returns true if a flush is still needed. (It may be that someone else |
| * is already in process of flushing that far, however.) |
| */ |
| bool |
| XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record) |
| { |
| /* |
| * During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint |
| * instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint |
| * would need to be updated. |
| */ |
| if (RecoveryInProgress()) |
| { |
| /* |
| * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the |
| * WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control |
| * file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks |
| * here too. This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process, |
| * which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as |
| * it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery. |
| */ |
| if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint) && InRecovery) |
| updateMinRecoveryPoint = false; |
| |
| /* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */ |
| if (record <= minRecoveryPoint || !updateMinRecoveryPoint) |
| return false; |
| |
| /* |
| * Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy, |
| * just return a conservative guess. |
| */ |
| if (!LWLockConditionalAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED)) |
| return true; |
| minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint; |
| minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI; |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| /* |
| * Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup |
| * process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control |
| * file value if crash recovery is still running. |
| */ |
| if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint)) |
| updateMinRecoveryPoint = false; |
| |
| /* check again */ |
| if (record <= minRecoveryPoint || !updateMinRecoveryPoint) |
| return false; |
| else |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Quick exit if already known flushed */ |
| if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| return false; |
| |
| /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* check again */ |
| if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush) |
| return false; |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Create a new XLOG file segment, or open a pre-existing one. |
| * |
| * logsegno: identify segment to be created/opened. |
| * |
| * *use_existent: if true, OK to use a pre-existing file (else, any |
| * pre-existing file will be deleted). On return, true if a pre-existing |
| * file was used. |
| * |
| * use_lock: if true, acquire ControlFileLock while moving file into |
| * place. This should be true except during bootstrap log creation. The |
| * caller must *not* hold the lock at call. |
| * |
| * Returns FD of opened file. |
| * |
| * Note: errors here are ERROR not PANIC because we might or might not be |
| * inside a critical section (eg, during checkpoint there is no reason to |
| * take down the system on failure). They will promote to PANIC if we are |
| * in a critical section. |
| */ |
| int |
| XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, bool *use_existent, bool use_lock) |
| { |
| char path[MAXPGPATH]; |
| char tmppath[MAXPGPATH]; |
| PGAlignedXLogBlock zbuffer; |
| XLogSegNo installed_segno; |
| XLogSegNo max_segno; |
| int fd; |
| int save_errno; |
| |
| XLogFilePath(path, ThisTimeLineID, logsegno, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* |
| * Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already) |
| */ |
| if (*use_existent) |
| { |
| fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method)); |
| if (fd < 0) |
| { |
| if (errno != ENOENT) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path))); |
| } |
| else |
| return fd; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment. NOTE: it is possible that |
| * another process is doing the same thing. If so, we will end up |
| * pre-creating an extra log segment. That seems OK, and better than |
| * holding the lock throughout this lengthy process. |
| */ |
| elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file"); |
| |
| snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid()); |
| |
| unlink(tmppath); |
| |
| /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */ |
| fd = BasicOpenFile(tmppath, O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY); |
| if (fd < 0) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath))); |
| |
| memset(zbuffer.data, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ); |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_WRITE); |
| save_errno = 0; |
| if (wal_init_zero) |
| { |
| struct iovec iov[PG_IOV_MAX]; |
| int blocks; |
| |
| /* |
| * Zero-fill the file. With this setting, we do this the hard way to |
| * ensure that all the file space has really been allocated. On |
| * platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end |
| * doesn't allocate intermediate space. This way, we know that we |
| * have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the |
| * indirect blocks are down on disk. Therefore, fdatasync(2) or |
| * O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file. |
| */ |
| |
| /* Prepare to write out a lot of copies of our zero buffer at once. */ |
| for (int i = 0; i < lengthof(iov); ++i) |
| { |
| iov[i].iov_base = zbuffer.data; |
| iov[i].iov_len = XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| } |
| |
| /* Loop, writing as many blocks as we can for each system call. */ |
| blocks = wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| for (int i = 0; i < blocks;) |
| { |
| int iovcnt = Min(blocks - i, lengthof(iov)); |
| off_t offset = i * XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| if (pg_pwritev_with_retry(fd, iov, iovcnt, offset) < 0) |
| { |
| save_errno = errno; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| i += iovcnt; |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is |
| * enough. |
| */ |
| errno = 0; |
| if (pg_pwrite(fd, zbuffer.data, 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1) |
| { |
| /* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */ |
| save_errno = errno ? errno : ENOSPC; |
| } |
| } |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| if (save_errno) |
| { |
| /* |
| * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space |
| */ |
| unlink(tmppath); |
| |
| close(fd); |
| |
| errno = save_errno; |
| |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath))); |
| } |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_SYNC); |
| if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0) |
| { |
| int save_errno = errno; |
| |
| close(fd); |
| errno = save_errno; |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath))); |
| } |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| if (close(fd) != 0) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Now move the segment into place with its final name. |
| * |
| * If caller didn't want to use a pre-existing file, get rid of any |
| * pre-existing file. Otherwise, cope with possibility that someone else |
| * has created the file while we were filling ours: if so, use ours to |
| * pre-create a future log segment. |
| */ |
| installed_segno = logsegno; |
| |
| /* |
| * XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when |
| * that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a |
| * checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but |
| * here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the |
| * normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to |
| * the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use |
| * CheckPointSegments. |
| */ |
| max_segno = logsegno + CheckPointSegments; |
| if (!InstallXLogFileSegment(&installed_segno, tmppath, |
| *use_existent, max_segno, |
| use_lock)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment() |
| * failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, opening |
| * the file below will fail. |
| */ |
| unlink(tmppath); |
| } |
| |
| /* Set flag to tell caller there was no existent file */ |
| *use_existent = false; |
| |
| /* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */ |
| fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method)); |
| if (fd < 0) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path), |
| (AmCheckpointerProcess() ? |
| errhint("This is known to fail occasionally during archive recovery, where it is harmless.") : |
| 0))); |
| |
| elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file"); |
| |
| return fd; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Create a new XLOG file segment by copying a pre-existing one. |
| * |
| * destsegno: identify segment to be created. |
| * |
| * srcTLI, srcsegno: identify segment to be copied (could be from |
| * a different timeline) |
| * |
| * upto: how much of the source file to copy (the rest is filled with |
| * zeros) |
| * |
| * Currently this is only used during recovery, and so there are no locking |
| * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to avoid |
| * emplacing a bogus file. |
| */ |
| static void |
| XLogFileCopy(XLogSegNo destsegno, TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno, |
| int upto) |
| { |
| char path[MAXPGPATH]; |
| char tmppath[MAXPGPATH]; |
| PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer; |
| int srcfd; |
| int fd; |
| int nbytes; |
| |
| /* |
| * Open the source file |
| */ |
| XLogFilePath(path, srcTLI, srcsegno, wal_segment_size); |
| srcfd = OpenTransientFile(path, O_RDONLY | PG_BINARY); |
| if (srcfd < 0) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Copy into a temp file name. |
| */ |
| snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid()); |
| |
| unlink(tmppath); |
| |
| /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */ |
| fd = OpenTransientFile(tmppath, O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY); |
| if (fd < 0) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Do the data copying. |
| */ |
| for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer)) |
| { |
| int nread; |
| |
| nread = upto - nbytes; |
| |
| /* |
| * The part that is not read from the source file is filled with |
| * zeros. |
| */ |
| if (nread < sizeof(buffer)) |
| memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer)); |
| |
| if (nread > 0) |
| { |
| int r; |
| |
| if (nread > sizeof(buffer)) |
| nread = sizeof(buffer); |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_READ); |
| r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread); |
| if (r != nread) |
| { |
| if (r < 0) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m", |
| path))); |
| else |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu", |
| path, r, (Size) nread))); |
| } |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| } |
| errno = 0; |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_WRITE); |
| if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer)) |
| { |
| int save_errno = errno; |
| |
| /* |
| * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space |
| */ |
| unlink(tmppath); |
| /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */ |
| errno = save_errno ? save_errno : ENOSPC; |
| |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath))); |
| } |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| } |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_SYNC); |
| if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0) |
| ereport(data_sync_elevel(ERROR), |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath))); |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath))); |
| |
| if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Now move the segment into place with its final name. |
| */ |
| if (!InstallXLogFileSegment(&destsegno, tmppath, false, 0, false)) |
| elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed"); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Install a new XLOG segment file as a current or future log segment. |
| * |
| * This is used both to install a newly-created segment (which has a temp |
| * filename while it's being created) and to recycle an old segment. |
| * |
| * *segno: identify segment to install as (or first possible target). |
| * When find_free is true, this is modified on return to indicate the |
| * actual installation location or last segment searched. |
| * |
| * tmppath: initial name of file to install. It will be renamed into place. |
| * |
| * find_free: if true, install the new segment at the first empty segno |
| * number at or after the passed numbers. If false, install the new segment |
| * exactly where specified, deleting any existing segment file there. |
| * |
| * max_segno: maximum segment number to install the new file as. Fail if no |
| * free slot is found between *segno and max_segno. (Ignored when find_free |
| * is false.) |
| * |
| * use_lock: if true, acquire ControlFileLock while moving file into |
| * place. This should be true except during bootstrap log creation. The |
| * caller must *not* hold the lock at call. |
| * |
| * Returns true if the file was installed successfully. false indicates that |
| * max_segno limit was exceeded, or an error occurred while renaming the |
| * file into place. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath, |
| bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, |
| bool use_lock) |
| { |
| char path[MAXPGPATH]; |
| struct stat stat_buf; |
| |
| XLogFilePath(path, ThisTimeLineID, *segno, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* |
| * We want to be sure that only one process does this at a time. |
| */ |
| if (use_lock) |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| |
| if (!find_free) |
| { |
| /* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */ |
| durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Find a free slot to put it in */ |
| while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0) |
| { |
| if ((*segno) >= max_segno) |
| { |
| /* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */ |
| if (use_lock) |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| return false; |
| } |
| (*segno)++; |
| XLogFilePath(path, ThisTimeLineID, *segno, wal_segment_size); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Perform the rename using link if available, paranoidly trying to avoid |
| * overwriting an existing file (there shouldn't be one). |
| */ |
| if (durable_rename_excl(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0) |
| { |
| if (use_lock) |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| /* durable_rename_excl already emitted log message */ |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| if (use_lock) |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Open a pre-existing logfile segment for writing. |
| */ |
| int |
| XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno) |
| { |
| char path[MAXPGPATH]; |
| int fd; |
| |
| XLogFilePath(path, ThisTimeLineID, segno, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method)); |
| if (fd < 0) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path))); |
| |
| return fd; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Open a logfile segment for reading (during recovery). |
| * |
| * If source == XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE, the segment is retrieved from archive. |
| * Otherwise, it's assumed to be already available in pg_wal. |
| */ |
| static int |
| XLogFileRead(XLogSegNo segno, int emode, TimeLineID tli, |
| XLogSource source, bool notfoundOk) |
| { |
| char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| char activitymsg[MAXFNAMELEN + 16]; |
| char path[MAXPGPATH]; |
| int fd; |
| |
| XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, segno, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| switch (source) |
| { |
| case XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE: |
| /* Report recovery progress in PS display */ |
| snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "waiting for %s", |
| xlogfname); |
| set_ps_display(activitymsg); |
| |
| restoredFromArchive = RestoreArchivedFile(path, xlogfname, |
| "RECOVERYXLOG", |
| wal_segment_size, |
| InRedo); |
| if (!restoredFromArchive) |
| return -1; |
| break; |
| |
| case XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL: |
| case XLOG_FROM_STREAM: |
| XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size); |
| restoredFromArchive = false; |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| elog(ERROR, "invalid XLogFileRead source %d", source); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If the segment was fetched from archival storage, replace the existing |
| * xlog segment (if any) with the archival version. |
| */ |
| if (source == XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE) |
| { |
| KeepFileRestoredFromArchive(path, xlogfname); |
| |
| /* |
| * Set path to point at the new file in pg_wal. |
| */ |
| snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlogfname); |
| } |
| |
| fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDONLY | PG_BINARY); |
| if (fd >= 0) |
| { |
| /* Success! */ |
| curFileTLI = tli; |
| |
| /* Report recovery progress in PS display */ |
| snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "recovering %s", |
| xlogfname); |
| set_ps_display(activitymsg); |
| |
| /* Track source of data in assorted state variables */ |
| readSource = source; |
| XLogReceiptSource = source; |
| /* In FROM_STREAM case, caller tracks receipt time, not me */ |
| if (source != XLOG_FROM_STREAM) |
| XLogReceiptTime = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| |
| return fd; |
| } |
| if (errno != ENOENT || !notfoundOk) /* unexpected failure? */ |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path))); |
| return -1; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Open a logfile segment for reading (during recovery). |
| * |
| * This version searches for the segment with any TLI listed in expectedTLEs. |
| */ |
| static int |
| XLogFileReadAnyTLI(XLogSegNo segno, int emode, XLogSource source) |
| { |
| char path[MAXPGPATH]; |
| ListCell *cell; |
| int fd; |
| List *tles; |
| |
| /* |
| * Loop looking for a suitable timeline ID: we might need to read any of |
| * the timelines listed in expectedTLEs. |
| * |
| * We expect curFileTLI on entry to be the TLI of the preceding file in |
| * sequence, or 0 if there was no predecessor. We do not allow curFileTLI |
| * to go backwards; this prevents us from picking up the wrong file when a |
| * parent timeline extends to higher segment numbers than the child we |
| * want to read. |
| * |
| * If we haven't read the timeline history file yet, read it now, so that |
| * we know which TLIs to scan. We don't save the list in expectedTLEs, |
| * however, unless we actually find a valid segment. That way if there is |
| * neither a timeline history file nor a WAL segment in the archive, and |
| * streaming replication is set up, we'll read the timeline history file |
| * streamed from the primary when we start streaming, instead of |
| * recovering with a dummy history generated here. |
| */ |
| if (expectedTLEs) |
| tles = expectedTLEs; |
| else |
| tles = readTimeLineHistory(recoveryTargetTLI); |
| |
| foreach(cell, tles) |
| { |
| TimeLineHistoryEntry *hent = (TimeLineHistoryEntry *) lfirst(cell); |
| TimeLineID tli = hent->tli; |
| |
| if (tli < curFileTLI) |
| break; /* don't bother looking at too-old TLIs */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Skip scanning the timeline ID that the logfile segment to read |
| * doesn't belong to |
| */ |
| if (hent->begin != InvalidXLogRecPtr) |
| { |
| XLogSegNo beginseg = 0; |
| |
| XLByteToSeg(hent->begin, beginseg, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* |
| * The logfile segment that doesn't belong to the timeline is |
| * older or newer than the segment that the timeline started or |
| * ended at, respectively. It's sufficient to check only the |
| * starting segment of the timeline here. Since the timelines are |
| * scanned in descending order in this loop, any segments newer |
| * than the ending segment should belong to newer timeline and |
| * have already been read before. So it's not necessary to check |
| * the ending segment of the timeline here. |
| */ |
| if (segno < beginseg) |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| if (source == XLOG_FROM_ANY || source == XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE) |
| { |
| fd = XLogFileRead(segno, emode, tli, |
| XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE, true); |
| if (fd != -1) |
| { |
| elog(DEBUG1, "got WAL segment from archive"); |
| if (!expectedTLEs) |
| expectedTLEs = tles; |
| return fd; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (source == XLOG_FROM_ANY || source == XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL) |
| { |
| fd = XLogFileRead(segno, emode, tli, |
| XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL, true); |
| if (fd != -1) |
| { |
| if (!expectedTLEs) |
| expectedTLEs = tles; |
| return fd; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Couldn't find it. For simplicity, complain about front timeline */ |
| XLogFilePath(path, recoveryTargetTLI, segno, wal_segment_size); |
| errno = ENOENT; |
| ereport(emode, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path))); |
| return -1; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Close the current logfile segment for writing. |
| */ |
| static void |
| XLogFileClose(void) |
| { |
| Assert(openLogFile >= 0); |
| |
| /* |
| * WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise |
| * the OS to release any cached pages. But do not do so if WAL archiving |
| * or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could |
| * use the cache to read the WAL segment. |
| */ |
| #if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED) |
| if (!XLogIsNeeded()) |
| (void) posix_fadvise(openLogFile, 0, 0, POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED); |
| #endif |
| |
| if (close(openLogFile) != 0) |
| { |
| char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| int save_errno = errno; |
| |
| XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, openLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| errno = save_errno; |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname))); |
| } |
| |
| openLogFile = -1; |
| ReleaseExternalFD(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Preallocate log files beyond the specified log endpoint. |
| * |
| * XXX this is currently extremely conservative, since it forces only one |
| * future log segment to exist, and even that only if we are 75% done with |
| * the current one. This is only appropriate for very low-WAL-volume systems. |
| * High-volume systems will be OK once they've built up a sufficient set of |
| * recycled log segments, but the startup transient is likely to include |
| * a lot of segment creations by foreground processes, which is not so good. |
| */ |
| static void |
| PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr) |
| { |
| XLogSegNo _logSegNo; |
| int lf; |
| bool use_existent; |
| uint64 offset; |
| |
| XLByteToPrevSeg(endptr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size); |
| if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size)) |
| { |
| _logSegNo++; |
| use_existent = true; |
| lf = XLogFileInit(_logSegNo, &use_existent, true); |
| close(lf); |
| if (!use_existent) |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added++; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Throws an error if the given log segment has already been removed or |
| * recycled. The caller should only pass a segment that it knows to have |
| * existed while the server has been running, as this function always |
| * succeeds if no WAL segments have been removed since startup. |
| * 'tli' is only used in the error message. |
| * |
| * Note: this function guarantees to keep errno unchanged on return. |
| * This supports callers that use this to possibly deliver a better |
| * error message about a missing file, while still being able to throw |
| * a normal file-access error afterwards, if this does return. |
| */ |
| void |
| CheckXLogRemoved(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli) |
| { |
| int save_errno = errno; |
| XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo) |
| { |
| char filename[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| |
| XLogFileName(filename, tli, segno, wal_segment_size); |
| errno = save_errno; |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed", |
| filename))); |
| } |
| errno = save_errno; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the last WAL segment removed, or 0 if no segment has been removed |
| * since startup. |
| * |
| * NB: the result can be out of date arbitrarily fast, the caller has to deal |
| * with that. |
| */ |
| XLogSegNo |
| XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void) |
| { |
| XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return lastRemovedSegNo; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the last removed segno pointer in shared memory, to reflect that the |
| * given XLOG file has been removed. |
| */ |
| static void |
| UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename) |
| { |
| uint32 tli; |
| XLogSegNo segno; |
| |
| XLogFromFileName(filename, &tli, &segno, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo) |
| XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove all temporary log files in pg_wal |
| * |
| * This is called at the beginning of recovery after a previous crash, |
| * at a point where no other processes write fresh WAL data. |
| */ |
| static void |
| RemoveTempXlogFiles(void) |
| { |
| DIR *xldir; |
| struct dirent *xlde; |
| |
| elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments"); |
| |
| xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR); |
| while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL) |
| { |
| char path[MAXPGPATH]; |
| |
| if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0) |
| continue; |
| |
| snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name); |
| unlink(path); |
| elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path); |
| } |
| FreeDir(xldir); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recycle or remove all log files older or equal to passed segno. |
| * |
| * endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the |
| * redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine |
| * whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files. |
| */ |
| static void |
| RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr) |
| { |
| DIR *xldir; |
| struct dirent *xlde; |
| char lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| XLogSegNo endlogSegNo; |
| XLogSegNo recycleSegNo; |
| |
| /* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to */ |
| XLByteToSeg(endptr, endlogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| recycleSegNo = XLOGfileslop(lastredoptr); |
| |
| /* |
| * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID |
| * doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery, |
| * ThisTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.) |
| */ |
| XLogFileName(lastoff, 0, segno, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s", |
| lastoff); |
| |
| xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR); |
| |
| while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL) |
| { |
| /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */ |
| if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) && |
| !IsPartialXLogFileName(xlde->d_name)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* |
| * We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in |
| * deciding whether a segment is still needed. This ensures that we |
| * won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could |
| * probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of |
| * non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more |
| * complicated. |
| * |
| * We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide |
| * which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment. |
| */ |
| if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0) |
| { |
| if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name)) |
| { |
| /* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */ |
| UpdateLastRemovedPtr(xlde->d_name); |
| |
| RemoveXlogFile(xlde->d_name, recycleSegNo, &endlogSegNo); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| FreeDir(xldir); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove WAL files that are not part of the given timeline's history. |
| * |
| * This is called during recovery, whenever we switch to follow a new |
| * timeline, and at the end of recovery when we create a new timeline. We |
| * wouldn't otherwise care about extra WAL files lying in pg_wal, but they |
| * might be leftover pre-allocated or recycled WAL segments on the old timeline |
| * that we haven't used yet, and contain garbage. If we just leave them in |
| * pg_wal, they will eventually be archived, and we can't let that happen. |
| * Files that belong to our timeline history are valid, because we have |
| * successfully replayed them, but from others we can't be sure. |
| * |
| * 'switchpoint' is the current point in WAL where we switch to new timeline, |
| * and 'newTLI' is the new timeline we switch to. |
| */ |
| static void |
| RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI) |
| { |
| DIR *xldir; |
| struct dirent *xlde; |
| char switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| XLogSegNo endLogSegNo; |
| XLogSegNo switchLogSegNo; |
| XLogSegNo recycleSegNo; |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize info about where to begin the work. This will recycle, |
| * somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments. |
| */ |
| XLByteToPrevSeg(switchpoint, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| XLByteToSeg(switchpoint, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| recycleSegNo = endLogSegNo + 10; |
| |
| /* |
| * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. |
| */ |
| XLogFileName(switchseg, newTLI, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s", |
| switchseg); |
| |
| xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR); |
| |
| while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL) |
| { |
| /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */ |
| if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name)) |
| continue; |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're |
| * switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the |
| * new timeline. |
| */ |
| if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 && |
| strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0) |
| { |
| /* |
| * If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't |
| * remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are |
| * not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery |
| * - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later. |
| */ |
| if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name)) |
| RemoveXlogFile(xlde->d_name, recycleSegNo, &endLogSegNo); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| FreeDir(xldir); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Recycle or remove a log file that's no longer needed. |
| * |
| * segname is the name of the segment to recycle or remove. recycleSegNo |
| * is the segment number to recycle up to. endlogSegNo is the segment |
| * number of the current (or recent) end of WAL. |
| * |
| * endlogSegNo gets incremented if the segment is recycled so as it is not |
| * checked again with future callers of this function. |
| */ |
| static void |
| RemoveXlogFile(const char *segname, XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, |
| XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo) |
| { |
| char path[MAXPGPATH]; |
| #ifdef WIN32 |
| char newpath[MAXPGPATH]; |
| #endif |
| struct stat statbuf; |
| |
| snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname); |
| |
| /* |
| * Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log |
| * segment. Only recycle normal files, because we don't want to recycle |
| * symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory. |
| */ |
| if (wal_recycle && |
| *endlogSegNo <= recycleSegNo && |
| lstat(path, &statbuf) == 0 && S_ISREG(statbuf.st_mode) && |
| InstallXLogFileSegment(endlogSegNo, path, |
| true, recycleSegNo, true)) |
| { |
| ereport(DEBUG2, |
| (errmsg_internal("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"", |
| segname))); |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled++; |
| /* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */ |
| (*endlogSegNo)++; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* No need for any more future segments... */ |
| int rc; |
| |
| ereport(DEBUG2, |
| (errmsg_internal("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"", |
| segname))); |
| |
| #ifdef WIN32 |
| |
| /* |
| * On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file |
| * open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file |
| * will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is |
| * closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live |
| * WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it. |
| * |
| * If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE |
| * flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint. |
| */ |
| snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path); |
| if (rename(path, newpath) != 0) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m", |
| path))); |
| return; |
| } |
| rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG); |
| #else |
| rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG); |
| #endif |
| if (rc != 0) |
| { |
| /* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */ |
| return; |
| } |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed++; |
| } |
| |
| XLogArchiveCleanup(segname); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Verify whether pg_wal and pg_wal/archive_status exist. |
| * If the latter does not exist, recreate it. |
| * |
| * It is not the goal of this function to verify the contents of these |
| * directories, but to help in cases where someone has performed a cluster |
| * copy for PITR purposes but omitted pg_wal from the copy. |
| * |
| * We could also recreate pg_wal if it doesn't exist, but a deliberate |
| * policy decision was made not to. It is fairly common for pg_wal to be |
| * a symlink, and if that was the DBA's intent then automatically making a |
| * plain directory would result in degraded performance with no notice. |
| */ |
| static void |
| ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void) |
| { |
| char path[MAXPGPATH]; |
| struct stat stat_buf; |
| |
| /* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */ |
| if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 || |
| !S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist", |
| XLOGDIR))); |
| |
| /* Check for archive_status */ |
| snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status"); |
| if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0) |
| { |
| /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */ |
| if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist", |
| path))); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path))); |
| if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m", |
| path))); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove previous backup history files. This also retries creation of |
| * .ready files for any backup history files for which XLogArchiveNotify |
| * failed earlier. |
| */ |
| static void |
| CleanupBackupHistory(void) |
| { |
| DIR *xldir; |
| struct dirent *xlde; |
| char path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)]; |
| |
| xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR); |
| |
| while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL) |
| { |
| if (IsBackupHistoryFileName(xlde->d_name)) |
| { |
| if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name)) |
| { |
| elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"", |
| xlde->d_name); |
| snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name); |
| unlink(path); |
| XLogArchiveCleanup(xlde->d_name); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| FreeDir(xldir); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Attempt to read the next XLOG record. |
| * |
| * Before first call, the reader needs to be positioned to the first record |
| * by calling XLogBeginRead(). |
| * |
| * If no valid record is available, returns NULL, or fails if emode is PANIC. |
| * (emode must be either PANIC, LOG). In standby mode, retries until a valid |
| * record is available. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecord * |
| ReadRecord(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, int emode, |
| bool fetching_ckpt) |
| { |
| XLogRecord *record; |
| XLogPageReadPrivate *private = (XLogPageReadPrivate *) xlogreader->private_data; |
| |
| /* Pass through parameters to XLogPageRead */ |
| private->fetching_ckpt = fetching_ckpt; |
| private->emode = emode; |
| private->randAccess = (xlogreader->ReadRecPtr == InvalidXLogRecPtr); |
| |
| /* This is the first attempt to read this page. */ |
| lastSourceFailed = false; |
| |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| char *errormsg; |
| |
| record = XLogReadRecord(xlogreader, &errormsg); |
| ReadRecPtr = xlogreader->ReadRecPtr; |
| EndRecPtr = xlogreader->EndRecPtr; |
| if (record == NULL) |
| { |
| /* |
| * When not in standby mode we find that WAL ends in an incomplete |
| * record, keep track of that record. After recovery is done, |
| * we'll write a record to indicate downstream WAL readers that |
| * that portion is to be ignored. |
| */ |
| if (!StandbyMode && |
| !XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(xlogreader->abortedRecPtr)) |
| { |
| abortedRecPtr = xlogreader->abortedRecPtr; |
| missingContrecPtr = xlogreader->missingContrecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| if (readFile >= 0) |
| { |
| close(readFile); |
| readFile = -1; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * We only end up here without a message when XLogPageRead() |
| * failed - in that case we already logged something. In |
| * StandbyMode that only happens if we have been triggered, so we |
| * shouldn't loop anymore in that case. |
| */ |
| if (errormsg) |
| ereport(emode_for_corrupt_record(emode, EndRecPtr), |
| (errmsg_internal("%s", errormsg) /* already translated */ )); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check page TLI is one of the expected values. |
| */ |
| else if (!tliInHistory(xlogreader->latestPageTLI, expectedTLEs)) |
| { |
| char fname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| XLogSegNo segno; |
| int32 offset; |
| |
| XLByteToSeg(xlogreader->latestPagePtr, segno, wal_segment_size); |
| offset = XLogSegmentOffset(xlogreader->latestPagePtr, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| XLogFileName(fname, xlogreader->seg.ws_tli, segno, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| ereport(emode_for_corrupt_record(emode, EndRecPtr), |
| (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u in log segment %s, offset %u", |
| xlogreader->latestPageTLI, |
| fname, |
| offset))); |
| record = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| if (record) |
| { |
| /* Great, got a record */ |
| return record; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* No valid record available from this source */ |
| lastSourceFailed = true; |
| |
| /* |
| * If archive recovery was requested, but we were still doing |
| * crash recovery, switch to archive recovery and retry using the |
| * offline archive. We have now replayed all the valid WAL in |
| * pg_wal, so we are presumably now consistent. |
| * |
| * We require that there's at least some valid WAL present in |
| * pg_wal, however (!fetching_ckpt). We could recover using the |
| * WAL from the archive, even if pg_wal is completely empty, but |
| * we'd have no idea how far we'd have to replay to reach |
| * consistency. So err on the safe side and give up. |
| */ |
| if (!InArchiveRecovery && ArchiveRecoveryRequested && |
| !fetching_ckpt) |
| { |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("reached end of WAL in pg_wal, entering archive recovery"))); |
| InArchiveRecovery = true; |
| if (StandbyModeRequested) |
| StandbyMode = true; |
| |
| /* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */ |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ControlFile->state = DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY; |
| if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr) |
| { |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr; |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = ThisTimeLineID; |
| } |
| /* update local copy */ |
| minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint; |
| minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI; |
| |
| /* |
| * The startup process can update its local copy of |
| * minRecoveryPoint from this point. |
| */ |
| updateMinRecoveryPoint = true; |
| |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| |
| /* |
| * We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on |
| * ControlFileLock so both states are consistent in shared |
| * memory. |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| CheckRecoveryConsistency(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Before we retry, reset lastSourceFailed and currentSource |
| * so that we will check the archive next. |
| */ |
| lastSourceFailed = false; |
| currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY; |
| |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| /* In standby mode, loop back to retry. Otherwise, give up. */ |
| if (StandbyMode && !CheckForStandbyTrigger()) |
| continue; |
| else |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Scan for new timelines that might have appeared in the archive since we |
| * started recovery. |
| * |
| * If there are any, the function changes recovery target TLI to the latest |
| * one and returns 'true'. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| rescanLatestTimeLine(void) |
| { |
| List *newExpectedTLEs; |
| bool found; |
| ListCell *cell; |
| TimeLineID newtarget; |
| TimeLineID oldtarget = recoveryTargetTLI; |
| TimeLineHistoryEntry *currentTle = NULL; |
| |
| newtarget = findNewestTimeLine(recoveryTargetTLI); |
| if (newtarget == recoveryTargetTLI) |
| { |
| /* No new timelines found */ |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Determine the list of expected TLIs for the new TLI |
| */ |
| |
| newExpectedTLEs = readTimeLineHistory(newtarget); |
| |
| /* |
| * If the current timeline is not part of the history of the new timeline, |
| * we cannot proceed to it. |
| */ |
| found = false; |
| foreach(cell, newExpectedTLEs) |
| { |
| currentTle = (TimeLineHistoryEntry *) lfirst(cell); |
| |
| if (currentTle->tli == recoveryTargetTLI) |
| { |
| found = true; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| if (!found) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("new timeline %u is not a child of database system timeline %u", |
| newtarget, |
| ThisTimeLineID))); |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * The current timeline was found in the history file, but check that the |
| * next timeline was forked off from it *after* the current recovery |
| * location. |
| */ |
| if (currentTle->end < EndRecPtr) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("new timeline %u forked off current database system timeline %u before current recovery point %X/%X", |
| newtarget, |
| ThisTimeLineID, |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndRecPtr)))); |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* The new timeline history seems valid. Switch target */ |
| recoveryTargetTLI = newtarget; |
| list_free_deep(expectedTLEs); |
| expectedTLEs = newExpectedTLEs; |
| |
| /* |
| * As in StartupXLOG(), try to ensure we have all the history files |
| * between the old target and new target in pg_wal. |
| */ |
| restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(oldtarget + 1, newtarget); |
| |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("new target timeline is %u", |
| recoveryTargetTLI))); |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * I/O routines for pg_control |
| * |
| * *ControlFile is a buffer in shared memory that holds an image of the |
| * contents of pg_control. WriteControlFile() initializes pg_control |
| * given a preloaded buffer, ReadControlFile() loads the buffer from |
| * the pg_control file (during postmaster or standalone-backend startup), |
| * and UpdateControlFile() rewrites pg_control after we modify xlog state. |
| * InitControlFile() fills the buffer with initial values. |
| * |
| * For simplicity, WriteControlFile() initializes the fields of pg_control |
| * that are related to checking backend/database compatibility, and |
| * ReadControlFile() verifies they are correct. We could split out the |
| * I/O and compatibility-check functions, but there seems no need currently. |
| */ |
| |
| static void |
| InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier) |
| { |
| char mock_auth_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN]; |
| |
| /* |
| * Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that |
| * will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create |
| * a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu |
| * of an actual stored password. |
| */ |
| if (!pg_strong_random(mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN)) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_INTERNAL_ERROR), |
| errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token"))); |
| |
| memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData)); |
| /* Initialize pg_control status fields */ |
| ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier; |
| memcpy(ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce, mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN); |
| ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED; |
| ControlFile->unloggedLSN = FirstNormalUnloggedLSN; |
| |
| /* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */ |
| ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections; |
| ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes; |
| ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders; |
| ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts; |
| ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact; |
| ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level; |
| ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints; |
| ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp; |
| ControlFile->data_checksum_version = bootstrap_data_checksum_version; |
| ControlFile->file_encryption_method = bootstrap_file_encryption_method; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| WriteControlFile(void) |
| { |
| int fd; |
| char buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE]; /* need not be aligned */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Ensure that the size of the pg_control data structure is sane. See the |
| * comments for these symbols in pg_control.h. |
| */ |
| StaticAssertStmt(sizeof(ControlFileData) <= PG_CONTROL_MAX_SAFE_SIZE, |
| "pg_control is too large for atomic disk writes"); |
| StaticAssertStmt(sizeof(ControlFileData) <= PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE, |
| "sizeof(ControlFileData) exceeds PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE"); |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize version and compatibility-check fields |
| */ |
| ControlFile->pg_control_version = PG_CONTROL_VERSION; |
| ControlFile->catalog_version_no = CATALOG_VERSION_NO; |
| |
| ControlFile->maxAlign = MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF; |
| ControlFile->floatFormat = FLOATFORMAT_VALUE; |
| |
| ControlFile->blcksz = BLCKSZ; |
| ControlFile->relseg_size = RELSEG_SIZE; |
| ControlFile->xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| ControlFile->xlog_seg_size = wal_segment_size; |
| |
| ControlFile->nameDataLen = NAMEDATALEN; |
| ControlFile->indexMaxKeys = INDEX_MAX_KEYS; |
| |
| ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size = TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE; |
| ControlFile->loblksize = LOBLKSIZE; |
| |
| ControlFile->float8ByVal = FLOAT8PASSBYVAL; |
| |
| /* Contents are protected with a CRC */ |
| INIT_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc); |
| COMP_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc, |
| (char *) ControlFile, |
| offsetof(ControlFileData, crc)); |
| FIN_CRC32C(ControlFile->crc); |
| |
| /* |
| * We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding |
| * the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData). This reduces the odds of |
| * premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control. We'll still fail when we |
| * check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific |
| * error than "couldn't read pg_control". |
| */ |
| memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE); |
| memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData)); |
| |
| fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, |
| O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY); |
| if (fd < 0) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", |
| XLOG_CONTROL_FILE))); |
| |
| errno = 0; |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_WRITE); |
| if (write(fd, buffer, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE) != PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE) |
| { |
| /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */ |
| if (errno == 0) |
| errno = ENOSPC; |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", |
| XLOG_CONTROL_FILE))); |
| } |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_SYNC); |
| if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", |
| XLOG_CONTROL_FILE))); |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| if (close(fd) != 0) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", |
| XLOG_CONTROL_FILE))); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| ReadControlFile(void) |
| { |
| pg_crc32c crc; |
| int fd; |
| static char wal_segsz_str[20]; |
| int r; |
| |
| /* |
| * Read data... |
| */ |
| fd = BasicOpenFile(XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, |
| O_RDWR | PG_BINARY); |
| if (fd < 0) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", |
| XLOG_CONTROL_FILE))); |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_READ); |
| r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData)); |
| if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData)) |
| { |
| if (r < 0) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m", |
| XLOG_CONTROL_FILE))); |
| else |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu", |
| XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData)))); |
| } |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| close(fd); |
| |
| /* |
| * Check for expected pg_control format version. If this is wrong, the |
| * CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number |
| * of bytes. Complaining about wrong version will probably be more |
| * enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC. |
| */ |
| |
| if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION && ControlFile->pg_control_version % 65536 == 0 && ControlFile->pg_control_version / 65536 != 0) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x)," |
| " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).", |
| ControlFile->pg_control_version, ControlFile->pg_control_version, |
| PG_CONTROL_VERSION, PG_CONTROL_VERSION), |
| errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering. It looks like you need to initdb."))); |
| |
| if (ControlFile->pg_control_version != PG_CONTROL_VERSION) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.", |
| ControlFile->pg_control_version, PG_CONTROL_VERSION), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to initdb."))); |
| |
| /* Now check the CRC. */ |
| INIT_CRC32C(crc); |
| COMP_CRC32C(crc, |
| (char *) ControlFile, |
| offsetof(ControlFileData, crc)); |
| FIN_CRC32C(crc); |
| |
| if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file"))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Do compatibility checking immediately. If the database isn't |
| * compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can |
| * possibly do any damage. |
| */ |
| if (ControlFile->catalog_version_no != CATALOG_VERSION_NO) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with CATALOG_VERSION_NO %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with CATALOG_VERSION_NO %d.", |
| ControlFile->catalog_version_no, CATALOG_VERSION_NO), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to initdb."))); |
| if (ControlFile->maxAlign != MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with MAXALIGN %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with MAXALIGN %d.", |
| ControlFile->maxAlign, MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to initdb."))); |
| if (ControlFile->floatFormat != FLOATFORMAT_VALUE) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to initdb."))); |
| if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with BLCKSZ %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with BLCKSZ %d.", |
| ControlFile->blcksz, BLCKSZ), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| if (ControlFile->relseg_size != RELSEG_SIZE) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with RELSEG_SIZE %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with RELSEG_SIZE %d.", |
| ControlFile->relseg_size, RELSEG_SIZE), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| if (ControlFile->xlog_blcksz != XLOG_BLCKSZ) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with XLOG_BLCKSZ %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with XLOG_BLCKSZ %d.", |
| ControlFile->xlog_blcksz, XLOG_BLCKSZ), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| if (ControlFile->nameDataLen != NAMEDATALEN) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with NAMEDATALEN %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with NAMEDATALEN %d.", |
| ControlFile->nameDataLen, NAMEDATALEN), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| if (ControlFile->indexMaxKeys != INDEX_MAX_KEYS) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with INDEX_MAX_KEYS %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with INDEX_MAX_KEYS %d.", |
| ControlFile->indexMaxKeys, INDEX_MAX_KEYS), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| if (ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size != TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE %d.", |
| ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size, (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| if (ControlFile->loblksize != LOBLKSIZE) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with LOBLKSIZE %d," |
| " but the server was compiled with LOBLKSIZE %d.", |
| ControlFile->loblksize, (int) LOBLKSIZE), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| |
| #ifdef USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL |
| if (ControlFile->float8ByVal != true) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized without USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL" |
| " but the server was compiled with USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL."), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| #else |
| if (ControlFile->float8ByVal != false) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL" |
| " but the server was compiled without USE_FLOAT8_BYVAL."), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| #endif |
| |
| wal_segment_size = ControlFile->xlog_seg_size; |
| |
| if (!IsValidWalSegSize(wal_segment_size)) |
| ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), |
| errmsg_plural("WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB, but the control file specifies %d byte", |
| "WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB, but the control file specifies %d bytes", |
| wal_segment_size, |
| wal_segment_size))); |
| |
| snprintf(wal_segsz_str, sizeof(wal_segsz_str), "%d", wal_segment_size); |
| SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL, |
| PGC_S_OVERRIDE); |
| |
| /* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */ |
| if (ConvertToXSegs(min_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2) |
| ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), |
| errmsg("\"min_wal_size\" must be at least twice \"wal_segment_size\""))); |
| |
| if (ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) < 2) |
| ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), |
| errmsg("\"max_wal_size\" must be at least twice \"wal_segment_size\""))); |
| |
| UsableBytesInSegment = |
| (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ * UsableBytesInPage) - |
| (SizeOfXLogLongPHD - SizeOfXLogShortPHD); |
| |
| CalculateCheckpointSegments(); |
| |
| /* Make the initdb settings visible as GUC variables, too */ |
| SetConfigOption("data_checksums", DataChecksumsEnabled() ? "yes" : "no", |
| PGC_INTERNAL, PGC_S_OVERRIDE); |
| |
| StaticAssertStmt(lengthof(encryption_methods) == NUM_ENCRYPTION_METHODS, |
| "encryption_methods[] must match NUM_ENCRYPTION_METHODS"); |
| |
| if (ControlFile->file_encryption_method < 0 || |
| ControlFile->file_encryption_method > NUM_ENCRYPTION_METHODS - 1) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"), |
| errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with file_encryption_method %d," |
| "The max value of file_encryption_method is: %d.", |
| ControlFile->file_encryption_method, NUM_ENCRYPTION_METHODS), |
| errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb."))); |
| |
| SetConfigOption("file_encryption_method", |
| encryption_methods[ControlFile->file_encryption_method].name, |
| PGC_INTERNAL, PGC_S_OVERRIDE); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Utility wrapper to update the control file. Note that the control |
| * file gets flushed. |
| */ |
| void |
| UpdateControlFile(void) |
| { |
| update_controlfile(DataDir, ControlFile, true); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns the unique system identifier from control file. |
| */ |
| uint64 |
| GetSystemIdentifier(void) |
| { |
| Assert(ControlFile != NULL); |
| return ControlFile->system_identifier; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns the random nonce from control file. |
| */ |
| char * |
| GetMockAuthenticationNonce(void) |
| { |
| Assert(ControlFile != NULL); |
| return ControlFile->mock_authentication_nonce; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Are checksums enabled for data pages? |
| */ |
| bool |
| DataChecksumsEnabled(void) |
| { |
| Assert(ControlFile != NULL); |
| return (ControlFile->data_checksum_version > 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Is cluster file encryption enabled? |
| */ |
| int |
| GetFileEncryptionMethod(void) |
| { |
| if (IsBootstrapProcessingMode()) |
| return bootstrap_file_encryption_method; |
| else |
| { |
| Assert(ControlFile != NULL); |
| return ControlFile->file_encryption_method; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns a fake LSN for unlogged relations. |
| * |
| * Each call generates an LSN that is greater than any previous value |
| * returned. The current counter value is saved and restored across clean |
| * shutdowns, but like unlogged relations, does not survive a crash. This can |
| * be used in lieu of real LSN values returned by XLogInsert, if you need an |
| * LSN-like increasing sequence of numbers without writing any WAL. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel(void) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr nextUnloggedLSN; |
| |
| /* increment the unloggedLSN counter, need SpinLock */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck); |
| nextUnloggedLSN = XLogCtl->unloggedLSN++; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck); |
| |
| return nextUnloggedLSN; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Auto-tune the number of XLOG buffers. |
| * |
| * The preferred setting for wal_buffers is about 3% of shared_buffers, with |
| * a maximum of one XLOG segment (there is little reason to think that more |
| * is helpful, at least so long as we force an fsync when switching log files) |
| * and a minimum of 8 blocks (which was the default value prior to PostgreSQL |
| * 9.1, when auto-tuning was added). |
| * |
| * This should not be called until NBuffers has received its final value. |
| */ |
| static int |
| XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void) |
| { |
| int xbuffers; |
| |
| xbuffers = NBuffers / 32; |
| if (xbuffers > (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ)) |
| xbuffers = (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ); |
| if (xbuffers < 8) |
| xbuffers = 8; |
| return xbuffers; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * GUC check_hook for wal_buffers |
| */ |
| bool |
| check_wal_buffers(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source) |
| { |
| /* |
| * -1 indicates a request for auto-tune. |
| */ |
| if (*newval == -1) |
| { |
| /* |
| * If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it |
| * be. We'll fix it when XLOGShmemSize is called. |
| */ |
| if (XLOGbuffers == -1) |
| return true; |
| |
| /* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */ |
| *newval = XLOGChooseNumBuffers(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks. Prior to PostgreSQL |
| * 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer |
| * the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the |
| * minimum. (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very |
| * helpful.) |
| */ |
| if (*newval < 4) |
| *newval = 4; |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Read the control file, set respective GUCs. |
| * |
| * This is to be called during startup, including a crash recovery cycle, |
| * unless in bootstrap mode, where no control file yet exists. As there's no |
| * usable shared memory yet (its sizing can depend on the contents of the |
| * control file!), first store the contents in local memory. XLOGShmemInit() |
| * will then copy it to shared memory later. |
| * |
| * reset just controls whether previous contents are to be expected (in the |
| * reset case, there's a dangling pointer into old shared memory), or not. |
| */ |
| void |
| LocalProcessControlFile(bool reset) |
| { |
| Assert(reset || ControlFile == NULL); |
| ControlFile = palloc(sizeof(ControlFileData)); |
| ReadControlFile(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialization of shared memory for XLOG |
| */ |
| Size |
| XLOGShmemSize(void) |
| { |
| Size size; |
| |
| /* |
| * If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value. |
| * This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till |
| * NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the |
| * value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important. |
| */ |
| if (XLOGbuffers == -1) |
| { |
| char buf[32]; |
| |
| snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers()); |
| SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER, PGC_S_OVERRIDE); |
| } |
| Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0); |
| |
| /* XLogCtl */ |
| size = sizeof(XLogCtlData); |
| |
| /* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */ |
| size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1)); |
| /* xlblocks array */ |
| size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(XLogRecPtr), XLOGbuffers)); |
| /* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */ |
| size = add_size(size, XLOG_BLCKSZ); |
| /* and the buffers themselves */ |
| size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Note: we don't count ControlFileData, it comes out of the "slop factor" |
| * added by CreateSharedMemoryAndSemaphores. This lets us use this |
| * routine again below to compute the actual allocation size. |
| */ |
| |
| return size; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| XLOGShmemInit(void) |
| { |
| bool foundCFile, |
| foundXLog; |
| char *allocptr; |
| int i; |
| ControlFileData *localControlFile; |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| |
| /* |
| * Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal |
| * "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if |
| * an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway. |
| */ |
| if (walDebugCxt == NULL) |
| { |
| walDebugCxt = AllocSetContextCreate(TopMemoryContext, |
| "WAL Debug", |
| ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES); |
| MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(walDebugCxt, true); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| |
| XLogCtl = (XLogCtlData *) |
| ShmemInitStruct("XLOG Ctl", XLOGShmemSize(), &foundXLog); |
| |
| localControlFile = ControlFile; |
| ControlFile = (ControlFileData *) |
| ShmemInitStruct("Control File", sizeof(ControlFileData), &foundCFile); |
| |
| if (foundCFile || foundXLog) |
| { |
| /* both should be present or neither */ |
| Assert(foundCFile && foundXLog); |
| |
| /* Initialize local copy of WALInsertLocks */ |
| WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks; |
| |
| if (localControlFile) |
| pfree(localControlFile); |
| return; |
| } |
| memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move |
| * contents into shared memory. |
| */ |
| if (localControlFile) |
| { |
| memcpy(ControlFile, localControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData)); |
| pfree(localControlFile); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a |
| * multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is |
| * needed here. |
| */ |
| allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData); |
| XLogCtl->xlblocks = (XLogRecPtr *) allocptr; |
| memset(XLogCtl->xlblocks, 0, sizeof(XLogRecPtr) * XLOGbuffers); |
| allocptr += sizeof(XLogRecPtr) * XLOGbuffers; |
| |
| |
| /* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */ |
| allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) - |
| ((uintptr_t) allocptr) % sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded); |
| WALInsertLocks = XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks = |
| (WALInsertLockPadded *) allocptr; |
| allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) * NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++) |
| { |
| LWLockInitialize(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LWTRANCHE_WAL_INSERT); |
| WALInsertLocks[i].l.insertingAt = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary. |
| * This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also |
| * required for O_DIRECT. |
| */ |
| allocptr = (char *) TYPEALIGN(XLOG_BLCKSZ, allocptr); |
| XLogCtl->pages = allocptr; |
| memset(XLogCtl->pages, 0, (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ * XLOGbuffers); |
| |
| /* |
| * Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill |
| * in additional info.) |
| */ |
| XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck = XLOGbuffers - 1; |
| XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH; |
| XLogCtl->SharedHotStandbyActive = false; |
| XLogCtl->SharedPromoteIsTriggered = false; |
| XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false; |
| |
| SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->Insert.insertpos_lck); |
| SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| SpinLockInit(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck); |
| InitSharedLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch); |
| ConditionVariableInit(&XLogCtl->recoveryNotPausedCV); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * This func must be called ONCE on system install. It creates pg_control |
| * and the initial XLOG segment. |
| */ |
| void |
| BootStrapXLOG(void) |
| { |
| CheckPoint checkPoint; |
| char *buffer; |
| XLogPageHeader page; |
| XLogLongPageHeader longpage; |
| XLogRecord *record; |
| char *recptr; |
| bool use_existent; |
| uint64 sysidentifier; |
| struct timeval tv; |
| pg_crc32c crc; |
| |
| /* |
| * Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation. |
| * We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds |
| * field, as being about as unique as we can easily get. (Think not to |
| * use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way |
| * to seed it other than the system clock value...) The upper half of the |
| * uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the |
| * tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current |
| * PID for a little extra uniqueness. A person knowing this encoding can |
| * determine the initialization time of the installation, which could |
| * perhaps be useful sometimes. |
| */ |
| gettimeofday(&tv, NULL); |
| sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32; |
| sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12; |
| sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF; |
| |
| /* First timeline ID is always 1 */ |
| ThisTimeLineID = 1; |
| |
| /* page buffer must be aligned suitably for O_DIRECT */ |
| buffer = (char *) palloc(XLOG_BLCKSZ + XLOG_BLCKSZ); |
| page = (XLogPageHeader) TYPEALIGN(XLOG_BLCKSZ, buffer); |
| memset(page, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ); |
| |
| /* |
| * Set up information for the initial checkpoint record |
| * |
| * The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL |
| * segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not |
| * used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment". |
| */ |
| checkPoint.redo = wal_segment_size + SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID; |
| checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID; |
| checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites; |
| checkPoint.nextXid = |
| FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(0, FirstNormalTransactionId); |
| checkPoint.nextGxid = FirstDistributedTransactionId; |
| checkPoint.nextOid = FirstBootstrapObjectId; |
| checkPoint.nextRelfilenode = FirstBootstrapObjectId; |
| checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId; |
| checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 0; |
| checkPoint.oldestXid = FirstNormalTransactionId; |
| checkPoint.oldestXidDB = TemplateDbOid; |
| checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId; |
| checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = TemplateDbOid; |
| checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextGxid = checkPoint.nextGxid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->GxidCount = 0; |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->oidCount = 0; |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextRelfilenode = checkPoint.nextRelfilenode; |
| ShmemVariableCache->relfilenodeCount = 0; |
| MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset); |
| AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid); |
| SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB); |
| SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB, true); |
| SetCommitTsLimit(InvalidTransactionId, InvalidTransactionId); |
| |
| /* Set up the XLOG page header */ |
| page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC; |
| page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER; |
| page->xlp_tli = ThisTimeLineID; |
| page->xlp_pageaddr = wal_segment_size; |
| longpage = (XLogLongPageHeader) page; |
| longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier; |
| longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size; |
| longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| /* Insert the initial checkpoint record */ |
| recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD); |
| record = (XLogRecord *) recptr; |
| record->xl_prev = 0; |
| record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint); |
| record->xl_info = XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN; |
| record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID; |
| recptr += SizeOfXLogRecord; |
| /* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */ |
| *(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT; |
| *(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint); |
| memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint)); |
| recptr += sizeof(checkPoint); |
| Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len); |
| |
| INIT_CRC32C(crc); |
| COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord); |
| COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc)); |
| FIN_CRC32C(crc); |
| record->xl_crc = crc; |
| |
| /* Create first XLOG segment file */ |
| use_existent = false; |
| openLogFile = XLogFileInit(1, &use_existent, false); |
| |
| /* |
| * We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll |
| * close the file again in a moment. |
| */ |
| |
| /* Write the first page with the initial record */ |
| errno = 0; |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_WRITE); |
| if (write(openLogFile, page, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ) |
| { |
| /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */ |
| if (errno == 0) |
| errno = ENOSPC; |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m"))); |
| } |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_SYNC); |
| if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m"))); |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| if (close(openLogFile) != 0) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m"))); |
| |
| openLogFile = -1; |
| |
| /* Now create pg_control */ |
| InitControlFile(sysidentifier); |
| ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time; |
| ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo; |
| ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint; |
| |
| /* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */ |
| WriteControlFile(); |
| |
| BootStrapKmgr(); |
| InitializeBufferEncryption(); |
| |
| if (terminal_fd != -1) |
| { |
| close(terminal_fd); |
| terminal_fd = -1; |
| } |
| |
| /* Bootstrap the commit log, too */ |
| BootStrapCLOG(); |
| BootStrapCommitTs(); |
| BootStrapSUBTRANS(); |
| BootStrapMultiXact(); |
| DistributedLog_BootStrap(); |
| |
| pfree(buffer); |
| |
| /* |
| * Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd |
| * otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein. |
| */ |
| ReadControlFile(); |
| } |
| |
| static char * |
| str_time(pg_time_t tnow) |
| { |
| static char buf[128]; |
| |
| pg_strftime(buf, sizeof(buf), |
| "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z", |
| pg_localtime(&tnow, log_timezone)); |
| |
| return buf; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * See if there are any recovery signal files and if so, set state for |
| * recovery. |
| * |
| * See if there is a recovery command file (recovery.conf), and if so |
| * throw an ERROR since as of PG12 we no longer recognize that. |
| */ |
| static void |
| readRecoverySignalFile(void) |
| { |
| struct stat stat_buf; |
| |
| if (IsBootstrapProcessingMode()) |
| return; |
| |
| /* |
| * Check for old recovery API file: recovery.conf |
| */ |
| if (stat(RECOVERY_COMMAND_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("using recovery command file \"%s\" is not supported", |
| RECOVERY_COMMAND_FILE))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove unused .done file, if present. Ignore if absent. |
| */ |
| unlink(RECOVERY_COMMAND_DONE); |
| |
| /* |
| * Check for recovery signal files and if found, fsync them since they |
| * represent server state information. We don't sweat too much about the |
| * possibility of fsync failure, however. |
| * |
| * If present, standby signal file takes precedence. If neither is present |
| * then we won't enter archive recovery. |
| */ |
| if (stat(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0) |
| { |
| int fd; |
| |
| fd = BasicOpenFilePerm(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method), |
| S_IRUSR | S_IWUSR); |
| if (fd >= 0) |
| { |
| (void) pg_fsync(fd); |
| close(fd); |
| } |
| standby_signal_file_found = true; |
| } |
| else if (stat(RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0) |
| { |
| int fd; |
| |
| fd = BasicOpenFilePerm(RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | get_sync_bit(sync_method), |
| S_IRUSR | S_IWUSR); |
| if (fd >= 0) |
| { |
| (void) pg_fsync(fd); |
| close(fd); |
| } |
| recovery_signal_file_found = true; |
| } |
| |
| StandbyModeRequested = false; |
| ArchiveRecoveryRequested = false; |
| if (standby_signal_file_found) |
| { |
| StandbyModeRequested = true; |
| ArchiveRecoveryRequested = true; |
| } |
| else if (recovery_signal_file_found) |
| { |
| StandbyModeRequested = false; |
| ArchiveRecoveryRequested = true; |
| } |
| else |
| return; |
| |
| /* |
| * We don't support standby mode in standalone backends; that requires |
| * other processes such as the WAL receiver to be alive. |
| */ |
| if (StandbyModeRequested && !IsUnderPostmaster) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED), |
| errmsg("standby mode is not supported by single-user servers"))); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| validateRecoveryParameters(void) |
| { |
| if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| return; |
| |
| /* |
| * Check for compulsory parameters |
| */ |
| if (StandbyModeRequested) |
| { |
| if ((PrimaryConnInfo == NULL || strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") == 0) && |
| (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0)) |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errmsg("specified neither primary_conninfo nor restore_command"), |
| errhint("The database server will regularly poll the pg_wal subdirectory to check for files placed there."))); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (recoveryRestoreCommand == NULL || |
| strcmp(recoveryRestoreCommand, "") == 0) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), |
| errmsg("must specify restore_command when standby mode is not enabled"))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Override any inconsistent requests. Note that this is a change of |
| * behaviour in 9.5; prior to this we simply ignored a request to pause if |
| * hot_standby = off, which was surprising behaviour. |
| */ |
| if (recoveryTargetAction == RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PAUSE && |
| !EnableHotStandby) |
| recoveryTargetAction = RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_SHUTDOWN; |
| |
| /* |
| * Final parsing of recovery_target_time string; see also |
| * check_recovery_target_time(). |
| */ |
| if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIME) |
| { |
| recoveryTargetTime = DatumGetTimestampTz(DirectFunctionCall3(timestamptz_in, |
| CStringGetDatum(recovery_target_time_string), |
| ObjectIdGetDatum(InvalidOid), |
| Int32GetDatum(-1))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If user specified recovery_target_timeline, validate it or compute the |
| * "latest" value. We can't do this until after we've gotten the restore |
| * command and set InArchiveRecovery, because we need to fetch timeline |
| * history files from the archive. |
| */ |
| if (recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_NUMERIC) |
| { |
| TimeLineID rtli = recoveryTargetTLIRequested; |
| |
| /* Timeline 1 does not have a history file, all else should */ |
| if (rtli != 1 && !existsTimeLineHistory(rtli)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), |
| errmsg("recovery target timeline %u does not exist", |
| rtli))); |
| recoveryTargetTLI = rtli; |
| } |
| else if (recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_LATEST) |
| { |
| /* We start the "latest" search from pg_control's timeline */ |
| recoveryTargetTLI = findNewestTimeLine(recoveryTargetTLI); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * else we just use the recoveryTargetTLI as already read from |
| * ControlFile |
| */ |
| Assert(recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_CONTROLFILE); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Exit archive-recovery state |
| */ |
| static void |
| exitArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog) |
| { |
| char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| XLogSegNo endLogSegNo; |
| XLogSegNo startLogSegNo; |
| |
| /* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */ |
| Assert(endTLI != ThisTimeLineID); |
| |
| /* |
| * We are no longer in archive recovery state. |
| */ |
| InArchiveRecovery = false; |
| |
| /* |
| * Update min recovery point one last time. |
| */ |
| UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true); |
| |
| /* |
| * If the ending log segment is still open, close it (to avoid problems on |
| * Windows with trying to rename or delete an open file). |
| */ |
| if (readFile >= 0) |
| { |
| close(readFile); |
| readFile = -1; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment |
| * on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment, |
| * they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment |
| * boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1. |
| */ |
| XLByteToPrevSeg(endOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| XLByteToSeg(endOfLog, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch |
| * happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment |
| * of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment |
| * on the new timeline. |
| */ |
| if (endLogSegNo == startLogSegNo) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Make a copy of the file on the new timeline. |
| * |
| * Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking |
| * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to |
| * avoid emplacing a bogus file. |
| */ |
| XLogFileCopy(endLogSegNo, endTLI, endLogSegNo, |
| XLogSegmentOffset(endOfLog, wal_segment_size)); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next |
| * segment on the new timeline. |
| */ |
| bool use_existent = true; |
| int fd; |
| |
| fd = XLogFileInit(startLogSegNo, &use_existent, true); |
| |
| if (close(fd) != 0) |
| { |
| char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| int save_errno = errno; |
| |
| XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, startLogSegNo, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| errno = save_errno; |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname))); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted |
| * for the new segment. |
| */ |
| XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| XLogArchiveCleanup(xlogfname); |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't accidentally |
| * re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash. |
| */ |
| if (standby_signal_file_found) |
| durable_unlink(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL); |
| |
| if (recovery_signal_file_found) |
| durable_unlink(RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, FATAL); |
| |
| /* |
| * Response to FTS probes after this point will not indicate that we are a |
| * mirror because the am_mirror flag is set based on existence of |
| * RECOVERY_COMMAND_FILE. New libpq connections to the postmaster should |
| * no longer return CAC_MIRROR_READY as response because we are no longer a |
| * mirror. |
| */ |
| ResetMirrorReadyFlag(); |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("archive recovery complete"))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Extract timestamp from WAL record. |
| * |
| * If the record contains a timestamp, returns true, and saves the timestamp |
| * in *recordXtime. If the record type has no timestamp, returns false. |
| * Currently, only transaction commit/abort records and restore points contain |
| * timestamps. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| getRecordTimestamp(XLogReaderState *record, TimestampTz *recordXtime) |
| { |
| uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK; |
| uint8 xact_info = info & XLOG_XACT_OPMASK; |
| uint8 rmid = XLogRecGetRmid(record); |
| |
| if (rmid == RM_XLOG_ID && info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT) |
| { |
| *recordXtime = ((xl_restore_point *) XLogRecGetData(record))->rp_time; |
| return true; |
| } |
| if (rmid == RM_XACT_ID && (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_DISTRIBUTED_COMMIT)) |
| { |
| *recordXtime = ((xl_xact_commit *) XLogRecGetData(record))->xact_time; |
| return true; |
| } |
| if (rmid == RM_XACT_ID && (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED)) |
| { |
| *recordXtime = ((xl_xact_abort *) XLogRecGetData(record))->xact_time; |
| return true; |
| } |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * For point-in-time recovery, this function decides whether we want to |
| * stop applying the XLOG before the current record. |
| * |
| * Returns true if we are stopping, false otherwise. If stopping, some |
| * information is saved in recoveryStopXid et al for use in annotating the |
| * new timeline's history file. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| recoveryStopsBefore(XLogReaderState *record) |
| { |
| bool stopsHere = false; |
| uint8 xact_info; |
| bool isCommit; |
| TimestampTz recordXtime = 0; |
| TransactionId recordXid; |
| |
| /* |
| * Ignore recovery target settings when not in archive recovery (meaning |
| * we are in crash recovery). |
| */ |
| if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| return false; |
| |
| /* Check if we should stop as soon as reaching consistency */ |
| if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_IMMEDIATE && reachedConsistency) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery stopping after reaching consistency"))); |
| |
| recoveryStopAfter = false; |
| recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| recoveryStopTime = 0; |
| recoveryStopName[0] = '\0'; |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Check if target LSN has been reached */ |
| if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_LSN && |
| !recoveryTargetInclusive && |
| record->ReadRecPtr >= recoveryTargetLSN) |
| { |
| recoveryStopAfter = false; |
| recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| recoveryStopLSN = record->ReadRecPtr; |
| recoveryStopTime = 0; |
| recoveryStopName[0] = '\0'; |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery stopping before WAL location (LSN) \"%X/%X\"", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(recoveryStopLSN)))); |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Otherwise we only consider stopping before COMMIT or ABORT records. */ |
| if (XLogRecGetRmid(record) != RM_XACT_ID) |
| return false; |
| |
| xact_info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & XLOG_XACT_OPMASK; |
| |
| if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_DISTRIBUTED_COMMIT) |
| { |
| isCommit = true; |
| recordXid = XLogRecGetXid(record); |
| } |
| else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED) |
| { |
| xl_xact_commit *xlrec = (xl_xact_commit *) XLogRecGetData(record); |
| xl_xact_parsed_commit parsed; |
| |
| isCommit = true; |
| ParseCommitRecord(XLogRecGetInfo(record), |
| xlrec, |
| &parsed); |
| recordXid = parsed.twophase_xid; |
| } |
| else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT) |
| { |
| isCommit = false; |
| recordXid = XLogRecGetXid(record); |
| } |
| else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED) |
| { |
| xl_xact_abort *xlrec = (xl_xact_abort *) XLogRecGetData(record); |
| xl_xact_parsed_abort parsed; |
| |
| isCommit = false; |
| ParseAbortRecord(XLogRecGetInfo(record), |
| xlrec, |
| &parsed); |
| recordXid = parsed.twophase_xid; |
| } |
| else |
| return false; |
| |
| if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_XID && !recoveryTargetInclusive) |
| { |
| /* |
| * There can be only one transaction end record with this exact |
| * transactionid |
| * |
| * when testing for an xid, we MUST test for equality only, since |
| * transactions are numbered in the order they start, not the order |
| * they complete. A higher numbered xid will complete before you about |
| * 50% of the time... |
| */ |
| stopsHere = (recordXid == recoveryTargetXid); |
| } |
| |
| if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIME && |
| getRecordTimestamp(record, &recordXtime)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * There can be many transactions that share the same commit time, so |
| * we stop after the last one, if we are inclusive, or stop at the |
| * first one if we are exclusive |
| */ |
| if (recoveryTargetInclusive) |
| stopsHere = (recordXtime > recoveryTargetTime); |
| else |
| stopsHere = (recordXtime >= recoveryTargetTime); |
| } |
| |
| if (stopsHere) |
| { |
| recoveryStopAfter = false; |
| recoveryStopXid = recordXid; |
| recoveryStopTime = recordXtime; |
| recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| recoveryStopName[0] = '\0'; |
| |
| if (isCommit) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery stopping before commit of transaction %u, time %s", |
| recoveryStopXid, |
| timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime)))); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery stopping before abort of transaction %u, time %s", |
| recoveryStopXid, |
| timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime)))); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return stopsHere; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * GPDB: Restore point records can act as a point of synchronization to ensure |
| * cluster-wide consistency during WAL replay. If a restore point is specified |
| * in the gp_pause_on_restore_point_replay GUC, WAL replay will be paused at |
| * that restore point until replay is explicitly resumed. |
| */ |
| static void |
| pauseRecoveryOnRestorePoint(XLogReaderState *record) |
| { |
| uint8 info; |
| uint8 rmid; |
| |
| /* |
| * Ignore recovery target settings when not in archive recovery (meaning |
| * we are in crash recovery). |
| */ |
| if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| return; |
| |
| info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK; |
| rmid = XLogRecGetRmid(record); |
| |
| if (rmid == RM_XLOG_ID && info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT) |
| { |
| xl_restore_point *recordRestorePointData; |
| |
| recordRestorePointData = (xl_restore_point *) XLogRecGetData(record); |
| |
| if (strcmp(recordRestorePointData->rp_name, gp_pause_on_restore_point_replay) == 0) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("setting recovery pause at restore point \"%s\", time %s", |
| recordRestorePointData->rp_name, |
| timestamptz_to_str(recordRestorePointData->rp_time)))); |
| |
| SetRecoveryPause(true); |
| recoveryPausesHere(false); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we've unpaused and there is a promotion request, then we've |
| * reached our continuous recovery target and need to immediately |
| * promote. We piggyback on the existing recovery target logic to |
| * do this. See recoveryStopsAfter(). |
| */ |
| if (CheckForStandbyTrigger()) |
| { |
| reachedContinuousRecoveryTarget = true; |
| recoveryTargetAction = RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PROMOTE; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Same as recoveryStopsBefore, but called after applying the record. |
| * |
| * We also track the timestamp of the latest applied COMMIT/ABORT |
| * record in XLogCtl->recoveryLastXTime. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| recoveryStopsAfter(XLogReaderState *record) |
| { |
| uint8 info; |
| uint8 xact_info; |
| uint8 rmid; |
| TimestampTz recordXtime = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Ignore recovery target settings when not in archive recovery (meaning |
| * we are in crash recovery). |
| */ |
| if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| return false; |
| |
| info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK; |
| rmid = XLogRecGetRmid(record); |
| |
| /* |
| * There can be many restore points that share the same name; we stop at |
| * the first one. |
| * |
| * GPDB: If we've reached the continuous recovery target, we'll use the |
| * below logic to immediately stop recovery. |
| */ |
| if ((reachedContinuousRecoveryTarget || recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_NAME) && |
| rmid == RM_XLOG_ID && info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT) |
| { |
| xl_restore_point *recordRestorePointData; |
| |
| recordRestorePointData = (xl_restore_point *) XLogRecGetData(record); |
| |
| if (reachedContinuousRecoveryTarget || |
| strcmp(recordRestorePointData->rp_name, recoveryTargetName) == 0) |
| { |
| recoveryStopAfter = true; |
| recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| (void) getRecordTimestamp(record, &recoveryStopTime); |
| strlcpy(recoveryStopName, recordRestorePointData->rp_name, MAXFNAMELEN); |
| |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery stopping at restore point \"%s\", time %s", |
| recoveryStopName, |
| timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime)))); |
| return true; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Check if the target LSN has been reached */ |
| if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_LSN && |
| recoveryTargetInclusive && |
| record->ReadRecPtr >= recoveryTargetLSN) |
| { |
| recoveryStopAfter = true; |
| recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| recoveryStopLSN = record->ReadRecPtr; |
| recoveryStopTime = 0; |
| recoveryStopName[0] = '\0'; |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery stopping after WAL location (LSN) \"%X/%X\"", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(recoveryStopLSN)))); |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| if (rmid != RM_XACT_ID) |
| return false; |
| |
| xact_info = info & XLOG_XACT_OPMASK; |
| |
| if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_DISTRIBUTED_COMMIT) |
| { |
| TransactionId recordXid; |
| |
| /* Update the last applied transaction timestamp */ |
| if (getRecordTimestamp(record, &recordXtime)) |
| SetLatestXTime(recordXtime); |
| |
| /* Extract the XID of the committed/aborted transaction */ |
| if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED) |
| { |
| xl_xact_commit *xlrec = (xl_xact_commit *) XLogRecGetData(record); |
| xl_xact_parsed_commit parsed; |
| |
| ParseCommitRecord(XLogRecGetInfo(record), |
| xlrec, |
| &parsed); |
| recordXid = parsed.twophase_xid; |
| } |
| else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED) |
| { |
| xl_xact_abort *xlrec = (xl_xact_abort *) XLogRecGetData(record); |
| xl_xact_parsed_abort parsed; |
| |
| ParseAbortRecord(XLogRecGetInfo(record), |
| xlrec, |
| &parsed); |
| recordXid = parsed.twophase_xid; |
| } |
| else |
| recordXid = XLogRecGetXid(record); |
| |
| /* |
| * There can be only one transaction end record with this exact |
| * transactionid |
| * |
| * when testing for an xid, we MUST test for equality only, since |
| * transactions are numbered in the order they start, not the order |
| * they complete. A higher numbered xid will complete before you about |
| * 50% of the time... |
| */ |
| if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_XID && recoveryTargetInclusive && |
| recordXid == recoveryTargetXid) |
| { |
| recoveryStopAfter = true; |
| recoveryStopXid = recordXid; |
| recoveryStopTime = recordXtime; |
| recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| recoveryStopName[0] = '\0'; |
| |
| if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_DISTRIBUTED_COMMIT) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery stopping after commit of transaction %u, time %s", |
| recoveryStopXid, |
| timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime)))); |
| } |
| else if (xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT || |
| xact_info == XLOG_XACT_ABORT_PREPARED) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery stopping after abort of transaction %u, time %s", |
| recoveryStopXid, |
| timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime)))); |
| } |
| return true; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Check if we should stop as soon as reaching consistency */ |
| if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_IMMEDIATE && reachedConsistency) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery stopping after reaching consistency"))); |
| |
| recoveryStopAfter = true; |
| recoveryStopXid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| recoveryStopTime = 0; |
| recoveryStopLSN = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| recoveryStopName[0] = '\0'; |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Wait until shared recoveryPauseState is set to RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED. |
| * |
| * endOfRecovery is true if the recovery target is reached and |
| * the paused state starts at the end of recovery because of |
| * recovery_target_action=pause, and false otherwise. |
| */ |
| static void |
| recoveryPausesHere(bool endOfRecovery) |
| { |
| /* Don't pause unless users can connect! */ |
| if (!LocalHotStandbyActive) |
| return; |
| |
| /* Don't pause after standby promotion has been triggered */ |
| if (LocalPromoteIsTriggered) |
| return; |
| |
| if (endOfRecovery) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("pausing at the end of recovery"), |
| errhint("Execute pg_wal_replay_resume() to promote."))); |
| else |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery has paused"), |
| errhint("Execute pg_wal_replay_resume() to continue."))); |
| |
| /* loop until recoveryPauseState is set to RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED */ |
| while (GetRecoveryPauseState() != RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED) |
| { |
| HandleStartupProcInterrupts(); |
| if (CheckForStandbyTrigger()) |
| return; |
| |
| /* |
| * If recovery pause is requested then set it paused. While we are in |
| * the loop, user might resume and pause again so set this every time. |
| */ |
| ConfirmRecoveryPaused(); |
| |
| /* |
| * We wait on a condition variable that will wake us as soon as the |
| * pause ends, but we use a timeout so we can check the above exit |
| * condition periodically too. |
| */ |
| ConditionVariableTimedSleep(&XLogCtl->recoveryNotPausedCV, 1000, |
| WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_PAUSE); |
| } |
| ConditionVariableCancelSleep(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get the current state of the recovery pause request. |
| */ |
| RecoveryPauseState |
| GetRecoveryPauseState(void) |
| { |
| RecoveryPauseState state; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| state = XLogCtl->recoveryPauseState; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return state; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Set the recovery pause state. |
| * |
| * If recovery pause is requested then sets the recovery pause state to |
| * 'pause requested' if it is not already 'paused'. Otherwise, sets it |
| * to 'not paused' to resume the recovery. The recovery pause will be |
| * confirmed by the ConfirmRecoveryPaused. |
| */ |
| void |
| SetRecoveryPause(bool recoveryPause) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| if (!recoveryPause) |
| XLogCtl->recoveryPauseState = RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED; |
| else if (XLogCtl->recoveryPauseState == RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED) |
| XLogCtl->recoveryPauseState = RECOVERY_PAUSE_REQUESTED; |
| |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| if (!recoveryPause) |
| ConditionVariableBroadcast(&XLogCtl->recoveryNotPausedCV); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Confirm the recovery pause by setting the recovery pause state to |
| * RECOVERY_PAUSED. |
| */ |
| static void |
| ConfirmRecoveryPaused(void) |
| { |
| /* If recovery pause is requested then set it paused */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| if (XLogCtl->recoveryPauseState == RECOVERY_PAUSE_REQUESTED) |
| XLogCtl->recoveryPauseState = RECOVERY_PAUSED; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * When recovery_min_apply_delay is set, we wait long enough to make sure |
| * certain record types are applied at least that interval behind the primary. |
| * |
| * Returns true if we waited. |
| * |
| * Note that the delay is calculated between the WAL record log time and |
| * the current time on standby. We would prefer to keep track of when this |
| * standby received each WAL record, which would allow a more consistent |
| * approach and one not affected by time synchronisation issues, but that |
| * is significantly more effort and complexity for little actual gain in |
| * usability. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| recoveryApplyDelay(XLogReaderState *record) |
| { |
| uint8 xact_info; |
| TimestampTz xtime; |
| TimestampTz delayUntil; |
| long msecs; |
| |
| /* nothing to do if no delay configured */ |
| if (recovery_min_apply_delay <= 0) |
| return false; |
| |
| /* no delay is applied on a database not yet consistent */ |
| if (!reachedConsistency) |
| return false; |
| |
| /* nothing to do if crash recovery is requested */ |
| if (!ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| return false; |
| |
| /* |
| * Is it a COMMIT record? |
| * |
| * We deliberately choose not to delay aborts since they have no effect on |
| * MVCC. We already allow replay of records that don't have a timestamp, |
| * so there is already opportunity for issues caused by early conflicts on |
| * standbys. |
| */ |
| if (XLogRecGetRmid(record) != RM_XACT_ID) |
| return false; |
| |
| xact_info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & XLOG_XACT_OPMASK; |
| |
| if (xact_info != XLOG_XACT_COMMIT && |
| xact_info != XLOG_XACT_COMMIT_PREPARED && |
| xact_info != XLOG_XACT_DISTRIBUTED_COMMIT) |
| return false; |
| |
| if (!getRecordTimestamp(record, &xtime)) |
| return false; |
| |
| delayUntil = TimestampTzPlusMilliseconds(xtime, recovery_min_apply_delay); |
| |
| /* |
| * Exit without arming the latch if it's already past time to apply this |
| * record |
| */ |
| msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(GetCurrentTimestamp(), delayUntil); |
| if (msecs <= 0) |
| return false; |
| |
| while (true) |
| { |
| ResetLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch); |
| |
| /* |
| * This might change recovery_min_apply_delay or the trigger file's |
| * location. |
| */ |
| HandleStartupProcInterrupts(); |
| |
| if (CheckForStandbyTrigger()) |
| break; |
| |
| /* |
| * Recalculate delayUntil as recovery_min_apply_delay could have |
| * changed while waiting in this loop. |
| */ |
| delayUntil = TimestampTzPlusMilliseconds(xtime, recovery_min_apply_delay); |
| |
| /* |
| * Wait for difference between GetCurrentTimestamp() and delayUntil. |
| */ |
| msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(GetCurrentTimestamp(), |
| delayUntil); |
| |
| if (msecs <= 0) |
| break; |
| |
| elog(DEBUG2, "recovery apply delay %ld milliseconds", msecs); |
| |
| (void) WaitLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch, |
| WL_LATCH_SET | WL_TIMEOUT | WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH, |
| msecs, |
| WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_APPLY_DELAY); |
| } |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Save timestamp of latest processed commit/abort record. |
| * |
| * We keep this in XLogCtl, not a simple static variable, so that it can be |
| * seen by processes other than the startup process. Note in particular |
| * that CreateRestartPoint is executed in the checkpointer. |
| */ |
| static void |
| SetLatestXTime(TimestampTz xtime) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->recoveryLastXTime = xtime; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Fetch timestamp of latest processed commit/abort record. |
| */ |
| TimestampTz |
| GetLatestXTime(void) |
| { |
| TimestampTz xtime; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| xtime = XLogCtl->recoveryLastXTime; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return xtime; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Save timestamp of the next chunk of WAL records to apply. |
| * |
| * We keep this in XLogCtl, not a simple static variable, so that it can be |
| * seen by all backends. |
| */ |
| static void |
| SetCurrentChunkStartTime(TimestampTz xtime) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->currentChunkStartTime = xtime; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Process passed checkpoint record either during normal recovery or |
| * in standby mode. |
| * |
| * If in standby mode, master mirroring information stored by the checkpoint |
| * record is processed as well. |
| */ |
| static void |
| XLogProcessCheckpointRecord(XLogReaderState *rec) |
| { |
| CheckpointExtendedRecord ckptExtended; |
| |
| UnpackCheckPointRecord(rec, &ckptExtended); |
| |
| if (ckptExtended.dtxCheckpoint) |
| { |
| /* Handle the DTX information. */ |
| redoDtxCheckPoint(ckptExtended.dtxCheckpoint); |
| /* |
| * Avoid closing the file here as possibly the file was already open |
| * and above call didn't really open it. Hence closing the same here |
| * is incorrect. |
| */ |
| } |
| } |
| |
| DBState |
| GetCurrentDBState(void) |
| { |
| Assert(ControlFile); |
| return ControlFile->state; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| UpdateCatalogForStandbyPromotion(void) |
| { |
| GpRoleValue old_role; |
| char *fullpath; |
| /* |
| * NOTE: The following initialization logic was borrowed from ftsprobe. |
| */ |
| SetProcessingMode(InitProcessing); |
| |
| /* |
| * Create a resource owner to keep track of our resources (currently only |
| * buffer pins). |
| */ |
| CurrentResourceOwner = ResourceOwnerCreate(NULL, "Startup Pass 4"); |
| |
| /* |
| * NOTE: AuxiliaryProcessMain has already called: |
| * NOTE: BaseInit, |
| * NOTE: InitAuxiliaryProcess instead of InitProcess, and |
| * NOTE: InitBufferPoolBackend. |
| */ |
| |
| InitXLOGAccess(); |
| |
| SetProcessingMode(NormalProcessing); |
| |
| /* |
| * Add my PGPROC struct to the ProcArray. |
| * |
| * Once I have done this, I am visible to other backends! |
| */ |
| InitProcessPhase2(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize my entry in the shared-invalidation manager's array of |
| * per-backend data. |
| * |
| * Sets up MyBackendId, a unique backend identifier. |
| */ |
| MyBackendId = InvalidBackendId; |
| |
| /* |
| * Though this is a startup process and currently no one sends invalidation |
| * messages concurrently, we set sendOnly = false, since we have relcaches. |
| */ |
| SharedInvalBackendInit(false); |
| |
| if (MyBackendId > MaxBackends || MyBackendId <= 0) |
| elog(FATAL, "bad backend id: %d", MyBackendId); |
| |
| /* |
| * bufmgr needs another initialization call too |
| */ |
| InitBufferPoolBackend(); |
| |
| /* Start transaction locally */ |
| old_role = Gp_role; |
| Gp_role = GP_ROLE_UTILITY; |
| StartTransactionCommand(); |
| GetTransactionSnapshot(); |
| |
| /* |
| * heap access requires the rel-cache. |
| */ |
| RelationCacheInitialize(); |
| InitCatalogCache(); |
| |
| /* |
| * It's now possible to do real access to the system catalogs. |
| * |
| * Load relcache entries for the system catalogs. This must create at |
| * least the minimum set of "nailed-in" cache entries. |
| */ |
| RelationCacheInitializePhase2(); |
| |
| /* |
| * In order to access the catalog, we need a database, and a |
| * tablespace; our access to the heap is going to be slightly |
| * limited, so we'll just use some defaults. |
| */ |
| if (!FindMyDatabase(DB_FOR_COMMON_ACCESS, &MyDatabaseId, &MyDatabaseTableSpace)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_UNDEFINED_DATABASE), |
| errmsg("database \"%s\" does not exit", DB_FOR_COMMON_ACCESS))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Now we can mark our PGPROC entry with the database ID |
| * (We assume this is an atomic store so no lock is needed) |
| */ |
| MyProc->databaseId = MyDatabaseId; |
| |
| fullpath = GetDatabasePath(MyDatabaseId, MyDatabaseTableSpace); |
| |
| SetDatabasePath(fullpath); |
| pfree(fullpath); |
| |
| RelationCacheInitializePhase3(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Now, finally, update the catalog. |
| */ |
| |
| /* I am privileged */ |
| InitializeSessionUserIdStandalone(); |
| gp_activate_standby(); |
| /* close the transaction we started above */ |
| CommitTransactionCommand(); |
| Gp_role = old_role; |
| |
| ereport(LOG, (errmsg("Updated catalog to support standby promotion"))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Fetch timestamp of latest processed commit/abort record. |
| * Startup process maintains an accurate local copy in XLogReceiptTime |
| */ |
| TimestampTz |
| GetCurrentChunkReplayStartTime(void) |
| { |
| TimestampTz xtime; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| xtime = XLogCtl->currentChunkStartTime; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return xtime; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns time of receipt of current chunk of XLOG data, as well as |
| * whether it was received from streaming replication or from archives. |
| */ |
| void |
| GetXLogReceiptTime(TimestampTz *rtime, bool *fromStream) |
| { |
| /* |
| * This must be executed in the startup process, since we don't export the |
| * relevant state to shared memory. |
| */ |
| Assert(InRecovery); |
| |
| *rtime = XLogReceiptTime; |
| *fromStream = (XLogReceiptSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Note that text field supplied is a parameter name and does not require |
| * translation |
| */ |
| static void |
| RecoveryRequiresIntParameter(const char *param_name, int currValue, int minValue) |
| { |
| if (currValue < minValue) |
| { |
| if (LocalHotStandbyActive) |
| { |
| bool warned_for_promote = false; |
| |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), |
| errmsg("hot standby is not possible because of insufficient parameter settings"), |
| errdetail("%s = %d is a lower setting than on the primary server, where its value was %d.", |
| param_name, |
| currValue, |
| minValue))); |
| |
| SetRecoveryPause(true); |
| |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("recovery has paused"), |
| errdetail("If recovery is unpaused, the server will shut down."), |
| errhint("You can then restart the server after making the necessary configuration changes."))); |
| |
| while (GetRecoveryPauseState() != RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED) |
| { |
| HandleStartupProcInterrupts(); |
| |
| if (CheckForStandbyTrigger()) |
| { |
| if (!warned_for_promote) |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), |
| errmsg("promotion is not possible because of insufficient parameter settings"), |
| |
| /* |
| * Repeat the detail from above so it's easy to find |
| * in the log. |
| */ |
| errdetail("%s = %d is a lower setting than on the primary server, where its value was %d.", |
| param_name, |
| currValue, |
| minValue), |
| errhint("Restart the server after making the necessary configuration changes."))); |
| warned_for_promote = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If recovery pause is requested then set it paused. While |
| * we are in the loop, user might resume and pause again so |
| * set this every time. |
| */ |
| ConfirmRecoveryPaused(); |
| |
| /* |
| * We wait on a condition variable that will wake us as soon |
| * as the pause ends, but we use a timeout so we can check the |
| * above conditions periodically too. |
| */ |
| ConditionVariableTimedSleep(&XLogCtl->recoveryNotPausedCV, 1000, |
| WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_PAUSE); |
| } |
| ConditionVariableCancelSleep(); |
| } |
| |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), |
| errmsg("recovery aborted because of insufficient parameter settings"), |
| /* Repeat the detail from above so it's easy to find in the log. */ |
| errdetail("%s = %d is a lower setting than on the primary server, where its value was %d.", |
| param_name, |
| currValue, |
| minValue), |
| errhint("You can restart the server after making the necessary configuration changes."))); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check to see if required parameters are set high enough on this server |
| * for various aspects of recovery operation. |
| * |
| * Note that all the parameters which this function tests need to be |
| * listed in Administrator's Overview section in high-availability.sgml. |
| * If you change them, don't forget to update the list. |
| */ |
| static void |
| CheckRequiredParameterValues(void) |
| { |
| /* |
| * For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica' |
| * wal_level. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && ControlFile->wal_level == WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL) |
| { |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errmsg("WAL was generated with wal_level=minimal, cannot continue recovering"), |
| errdetail("This happens if you temporarily set wal_level=minimal on the server."), |
| errhint("Use a backup taken after setting wal_level to higher than minimal."))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we |
| * must have at least as many backend slots as the primary. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby) |
| { |
| /* We ignore autovacuum_max_workers when we make this test. */ |
| RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections", |
| MaxConnections, |
| ControlFile->MaxConnections); |
| RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes", |
| max_worker_processes, |
| ControlFile->max_worker_processes); |
| RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders", |
| max_wal_senders, |
| ControlFile->max_wal_senders); |
| RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions", |
| max_prepared_xacts, |
| ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts); |
| RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction", |
| max_locks_per_xact, |
| ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend startup |
| */ |
| void |
| StartupXLOG(void) |
| { |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert; |
| CheckPoint checkPoint; |
| bool wasShutdown; |
| bool reachedRecoveryTarget = false; |
| bool haveBackupLabel = false; |
| bool haveTblspcMap = false; |
| XLogRecPtr RecPtr, |
| checkPointLoc, |
| EndOfLog; |
| TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI; |
| TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID; |
| XLogRecord *record; |
| TransactionId oldestActiveXID; |
| bool backupEndRequired = false; |
| bool backupFromStandby = false; |
| DBState dbstate_at_startup; |
| XLogReaderState *xlogreader; |
| XLogPageReadPrivate private; |
| bool promoted = false; |
| struct stat st; |
| |
| /* |
| * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not |
| * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner. |
| */ |
| Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL); |
| Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL || |
| CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner); |
| CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner; |
| |
| /* |
| * Check that contents look valid. |
| */ |
| if (!XRecOffIsValid(ControlFile->checkPoint)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location"))); |
| |
| switch (ControlFile->state) |
| { |
| case DB_SHUTDOWNED: |
| |
| /* |
| * This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone |
| * mode |
| */ |
| ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE, |
| (errmsg("database system was shut down at %s", |
| str_time(ControlFile->time)))); |
| break; |
| |
| case DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s", |
| str_time(ControlFile->time)))); |
| break; |
| |
| case DB_SHUTDOWNING: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s", |
| str_time(ControlFile->time)))); |
| break; |
| |
| case DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s", |
| str_time(ControlFile->time)), |
| errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and" |
| " you will have to use the last backup for recovery."))); |
| break; |
| |
| case DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s", |
| str_time(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.time)), |
| errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted" |
| " and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target."))); |
| break; |
| |
| case DB_IN_PRODUCTION: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s", |
| str_time(ControlFile->time)))); |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state"))); |
| } |
| |
| /* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */ |
| #ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY |
| if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED) |
| pg_usleep(60000000L); |
| #endif |
| |
| /* |
| * Verify that pg_wal and pg_wal/archive_status exist. In cases where |
| * someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories may have been |
| * excluded and need to be re-created. |
| */ |
| ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(); |
| |
| /*---------- |
| * If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions: |
| * - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments |
| * used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not |
| * bloat this path. This is done first as there is no point to sync this |
| * temporary data. |
| * - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, |
| * but which we had not actually fsync'd yet. Therefore, a power failure |
| * in the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, |
| * even though more recent data written to disk from here on would be |
| * persisted. To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory. |
| * |
| * GPDB: We don't force to fsync the whole pgdata directory as upstream |
| * code since that could be very slow in cases that the pgdata |
| * directory has a lot of (e.g. millions of) files. See below for details. |
| *--------- |
| */ |
| if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED && |
| ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY) |
| { |
| RemoveTempXlogFiles(); |
| /* |
| * 1. If the backup_label file exists, we assume the pgdata has already |
| * been synchronized. This is true on gpdb since we do force fsync |
| * during pg_basebackup and pg_rewind. |
| * |
| * 2. else for the crash recovery case. |
| * |
| * 2.1. if full page writes is enabled, we do synchronize the wal |
| * files only. wal files must be synchronized here, else if xlog |
| * redo writes some buffer pages and those pages are partly |
| * synchronized, and then system crashes and some xlogs are lost, |
| * those table file pages might be broken. |
| * |
| * 2.2. else, simply synchronize the whole pgdata directory though |
| * there might be room for optimization but we would mostly not run |
| * into this code branch. Since we can not get |
| * checkPoint.fullPageWrites here so we do pgdata fsync later ( |
| * i.e. call SyncDataDirectory()) after reading the checkpoint. |
| */ |
| if (access(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, F_OK) != 0) |
| SyncAllXLogFiles(); |
| if (Gp_role == GP_ROLE_DISPATCH) |
| *shmCleanupBackends = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize on the assumption we want to recover to the latest timeline |
| * that's active according to pg_control. |
| */ |
| if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI > |
| ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID) |
| recoveryTargetTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI; |
| else |
| recoveryTargetTLI = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID; |
| |
| /* |
| * Check for signal files, and if so set up state for offline recovery |
| */ |
| readRecoverySignalFile(); |
| validateRecoveryParameters(); |
| |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| { |
| if (StandbyModeRequested) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("entering standby mode"))); |
| else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_XID) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to XID %u", |
| recoveryTargetXid))); |
| else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIME) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to %s", |
| timestamptz_to_str(recoveryTargetTime)))); |
| else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_NAME) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to \"%s\"", |
| recoveryTargetName))); |
| else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_LSN) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to WAL location (LSN) \"%X/%X\"", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(recoveryTargetLSN)))); |
| else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_IMMEDIATE) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("starting point-in-time recovery to earliest consistent point"))); |
| else |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("starting archive recovery"))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Take ownership of the wakeup latch if we're going to sleep during |
| * recovery. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| OwnLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch); |
| |
| /* Set up XLOG reader facility */ |
| MemSet(&private, 0, sizeof(XLogPageReadPrivate)); |
| xlogreader = |
| XLogReaderAllocate(wal_segment_size, NULL, |
| XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = &XLogPageRead, |
| .segment_open = NULL, |
| .segment_close = wal_segment_close), |
| &private); |
| if (!xlogreader) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OUT_OF_MEMORY), |
| errmsg("out of memory"), |
| errdetail("Failed while allocating a WAL reading processor."))); |
| xlogreader->system_identifier = ControlFile->system_identifier; |
| |
| /* |
| * Allocate two page buffers dedicated to WAL consistency checks. We do |
| * it this way, rather than just making static arrays, for two reasons: |
| * (1) no need to waste the storage in most instantiations of the backend; |
| * (2) a static char array isn't guaranteed to have any particular |
| * alignment, whereas palloc() will provide MAXALIGN'd storage. |
| */ |
| replay_image_masked = (char *) palloc(BLCKSZ); |
| primary_image_masked = (char *) palloc(BLCKSZ); |
| |
| if (read_backup_label(&checkPointLoc, &backupEndRequired, |
| &backupFromStandby)) |
| { |
| List *tablespaces = NIL; |
| |
| /* |
| * Archive recovery was requested, and thanks to the backup label |
| * file, we know how far we need to replay to reach consistency. Enter |
| * archive recovery directly. |
| */ |
| InArchiveRecovery = true; |
| if (StandbyModeRequested) |
| StandbyMode = true; |
| |
| /* |
| * When a backup_label file is present, we want to roll forward from |
| * the checkpoint it identifies, rather than using pg_control. |
| */ |
| record = ReadCheckpointRecord(xlogreader, checkPointLoc, 0, true); |
| if (record != NULL) |
| { |
| memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(xlogreader), sizeof(CheckPoint)); |
| wasShutdown = ((record->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK) == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN); |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("checkpoint record is at %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPointLoc)))); |
| InRecovery = true; /* force recovery even if SHUTDOWNED */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Make sure that REDO location exists. This may not be the case |
| * if there was a crash during an online backup, which left a |
| * backup_label around that references a WAL segment that's |
| * already been archived. |
| */ |
| if (checkPoint.redo < checkPointLoc) |
| { |
| XLogBeginRead(xlogreader, checkPoint.redo); |
| if (!ReadRecord(xlogreader, LOG, false)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("could not find redo location referenced by checkpoint record"), |
| errhint("If you are restoring from a backup, touch \"%s/recovery.signal\" and add required recovery options.\n" |
| "If you are not restoring from a backup, try removing the file \"%s/backup_label\".\n" |
| "Be careful: removing \"%s/backup_label\" will result in a corrupt cluster if restoring from a backup.", |
| DataDir, DataDir, DataDir))); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("could not locate required checkpoint record"), |
| errhint("If you are restoring from a backup, touch \"%s/recovery.signal\" and add required recovery options.\n" |
| "If you are not restoring from a backup, try removing the file \"%s/backup_label\".\n" |
| "Be careful: removing \"%s/backup_label\" will result in a corrupt cluster if restoring from a backup.", |
| DataDir, DataDir, DataDir))); |
| wasShutdown = false; /* keep compiler quiet */ |
| } |
| |
| /* read the tablespace_map file if present and create symlinks. */ |
| if (read_tablespace_map(&tablespaces)) |
| { |
| ListCell *lc; |
| |
| foreach(lc, tablespaces) |
| { |
| tablespaceinfo *ti = lfirst(lc); |
| char *linkloc; |
| |
| linkloc = psprintf("pg_tblspc/%s", ti->oid); |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove the existing symlink if any and Create the symlink |
| * under PGDATA. |
| */ |
| remove_tablespace_symlink(linkloc); |
| |
| if (symlink(ti->path, linkloc) < 0) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not create symbolic link \"%s\": %m", |
| linkloc))); |
| |
| pfree(ti->oid); |
| pfree(ti->path); |
| pfree(ti); |
| } |
| |
| /* set flag to delete it later */ |
| haveTblspcMap = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* set flag to delete it later */ |
| haveBackupLabel = true; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * If tablespace_map file is present without backup_label file, there |
| * is no use of such file. There is no harm in retaining it, but it |
| * is better to get rid of the map file so that we don't have any |
| * redundant file in data directory and it will avoid any sort of |
| * confusion. It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of |
| * the way rather than delete it completely, also we ignore any error |
| * that occurs in rename operation as even if map file is present |
| * without backup_label file, it is harmless. |
| */ |
| if (stat(TABLESPACE_MAP, &st) == 0) |
| { |
| unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD); |
| if (durable_rename(TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, DEBUG1) == 0) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("ignoring file \"%s\" because no file \"%s\" exists", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE), |
| errdetail("File \"%s\" was renamed to \"%s\".", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD))); |
| else |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("ignoring file \"%s\" because no file \"%s\" exists", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE), |
| errdetail("Could not rename file \"%s\" to \"%s\": %m.", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * It's possible that archive recovery was requested, but we don't |
| * know how far we need to replay the WAL before we reach consistency. |
| * This can happen for example if a base backup is taken from a |
| * running server using an atomic filesystem snapshot, without calling |
| * pg_start/stop_backup. Or if you just kill a running primary server |
| * and put it into archive recovery by creating a recovery signal |
| * file. |
| * |
| * Our strategy in that case is to perform crash recovery first, |
| * replaying all the WAL present in pg_wal, and only enter archive |
| * recovery after that. |
| * |
| * But usually we already know how far we need to replay the WAL (up |
| * to minRecoveryPoint, up to backupEndPoint, or until we see an |
| * end-of-backup record), and we can enter archive recovery directly. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && |
| (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint != InvalidXLogRecPtr || |
| ControlFile->backupEndRequired || |
| ControlFile->backupEndPoint != InvalidXLogRecPtr || |
| ControlFile->state == DB_SHUTDOWNED)) |
| { |
| InArchiveRecovery = true; |
| if (StandbyModeRequested) |
| StandbyMode = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* Get the last valid checkpoint record. */ |
| checkPointLoc = ControlFile->checkPoint; |
| RedoStartLSN = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo; |
| record = ReadCheckpointRecord(xlogreader, checkPointLoc, 1, true); |
| if (record != NULL) |
| { |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("checkpoint record is at %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPointLoc)))); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * We used to attempt to go back to a secondary checkpoint record |
| * here, but only when not in standby mode. We now just fail if we |
| * can't read the last checkpoint because this allows us to |
| * simplify processing around checkpoints. |
| */ |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("could not locate a valid checkpoint record"))); |
| } |
| memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(xlogreader), sizeof(CheckPoint)); |
| wasShutdown = ((record->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK) == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * gpdb specific: Do pgdata fsync for the case that is almost not possible |
| * on real production scenarios. See previous code that calls |
| * SyncAllXLogFiles() for details. |
| */ |
| if (!checkPoint.fullPageWrites && |
| !haveBackupLabel && |
| ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED && |
| ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY) |
| SyncDataDirectory(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Clear out any old relcache cache files. This is *necessary* if we do |
| * any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files |
| * being out of sync with database reality. In theory we could leave them |
| * in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems |
| * safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the |
| * first backend startup. These files needs to be removed from all |
| * directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only |
| * after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from |
| * backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating |
| * symlinks. |
| */ |
| RelationCacheInitFileRemove(); |
| |
| /* |
| * If the location of the checkpoint record is not on the expected |
| * timeline in the history of the requested timeline, we cannot proceed: |
| * the backup is not part of the history of the requested timeline. |
| */ |
| Assert(expectedTLEs); /* was initialized by reading checkpoint |
| * record */ |
| if (tliOfPointInHistory(checkPointLoc, expectedTLEs) != |
| checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr switchpoint; |
| |
| /* |
| * tliSwitchPoint will throw an error if the checkpoint's timeline is |
| * not in expectedTLEs at all. |
| */ |
| switchpoint = tliSwitchPoint(ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID, expectedTLEs, NULL); |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("requested timeline %u is not a child of this server's history", |
| recoveryTargetTLI), |
| errdetail("Latest checkpoint is at %X/%X on timeline %u, but in the history of the requested timeline, the server forked off from that timeline at %X/%X.", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->checkPoint), |
| ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID, |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(switchpoint)))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * The min recovery point should be part of the requested timeline's |
| * history, too. |
| */ |
| if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint) && |
| tliOfPointInHistory(ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint - 1, expectedTLEs) != |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("requested timeline %u does not contain minimum recovery point %X/%X on timeline %u", |
| recoveryTargetTLI, |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint), |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI))); |
| |
| LastRec = RecPtr = checkPointLoc; |
| |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("redo record is at %X/%X; shutdown %s", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint.redo), |
| wasShutdown ? "true" : "false"))); |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("next transaction ID: " UINT64_FORMAT "; next OID: %u; next relfilenode: %u", |
| U64FromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid), |
| checkPoint.nextOid, checkPoint.nextRelfilenode))); |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("next MultiXactId: %u; next MultiXactOffset: %u", |
| checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset))); |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("oldest unfrozen transaction ID: %u, in database %u", |
| checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB))); |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("oldest MultiXactId: %u, in database %u", |
| checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB))); |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("commit timestamp Xid oldest/newest: %u/%u", |
| checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid, |
| checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid))); |
| if (!TransactionIdIsNormal(XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid))) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("invalid next transaction ID"))); |
| |
| /* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */ |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextGxid = checkPoint.nextGxid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->GxidCount = 0; |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->oidCount = 0; |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextRelfilenode = checkPoint.nextRelfilenode; |
| ShmemVariableCache->relfilenodeCount = 0; |
| MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset); |
| AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid); |
| SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB); |
| SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB, true); |
| SetCommitTsLimit(checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid, |
| checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid); |
| XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove |
| * required resources. |
| */ |
| StartupReplicationSlots(); |
| |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| ReplicationSlotDropIfExists(INTERNAL_WAL_REPLICATION_SLOT_NAME); |
| |
| /* |
| * Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data |
| * during crash recovery. |
| */ |
| StartupReorderBuffer(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Startup CLOG. This must be done after ShmemVariableCache->nextXid has |
| * been initialized and before we accept connections or begin WAL replay. |
| */ |
| StartupCLOG(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay |
| * truncations. |
| */ |
| StartupMultiXact(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Ditto for commit timestamps. Activate the facility if the setting is |
| * enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit |
| * timestamps done when the setting was disabled. This facility can be |
| * started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record. |
| */ |
| if (ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp) |
| StartupCommitTs(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners. |
| */ |
| StartupReplicationOrigin(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the |
| * control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so |
| * the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too. |
| */ |
| if (ControlFile->state == DB_SHUTDOWNED) |
| XLogCtl->unloggedLSN = ControlFile->unloggedLSN; |
| else |
| XLogCtl->unloggedLSN = FirstNormalUnloggedLSN; |
| |
| /* |
| * We must replay WAL entries using the same TimeLineID they were created |
| * under, so temporarily adopt the TLI indicated by the checkpoint (see |
| * also xlog_redo()). |
| */ |
| ThisTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID; |
| |
| /* |
| * Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery |
| * target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files |
| * ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all |
| * the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server |
| * might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this |
| * server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all |
| * the history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can |
| * use one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files |
| * are small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them |
| * and regret later. |
| */ |
| restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(ThisTimeLineID, recoveryTargetTLI); |
| |
| /* |
| * Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to |
| * be able to work on entries generated by redo. Doing a scan before |
| * taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that |
| * are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at |
| * replay. This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery |
| * of the on-disk two-phase data. |
| */ |
| restoreTwoPhaseData(); |
| |
| lastFullPageWrites = checkPoint.fullPageWrites; |
| |
| RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo; |
| doPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites; |
| |
| if (RecPtr < checkPoint.redo) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("invalid redo in checkpoint record"))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Check whether we need to force recovery from WAL. If it appears to |
| * have been a clean shutdown and we did not have a recovery signal file, |
| * then assume no recovery needed. |
| */ |
| if (checkPoint.redo < RecPtr) |
| { |
| if (wasShutdown) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("invalid redo record in shutdown checkpoint"))); |
| InRecovery = true; |
| } |
| else if (ControlFile->state != DB_SHUTDOWNED) |
| InRecovery = true; |
| else if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| { |
| /* force recovery due to presence of recovery signal file */ |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("setting recovery standby mode active"))); |
| InRecovery = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Start recovery assuming that the final record isn't lost. |
| */ |
| abortedRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| missingContrecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| |
| /* REDO */ |
| if (InRecovery) |
| { |
| int rmid; |
| |
| /* |
| * Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the |
| * selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark |
| * pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a |
| * backup history file. |
| */ |
| dbstate_at_startup = ControlFile->state; |
| if (InArchiveRecovery) |
| { |
| ControlFile->state = DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("database system was not properly shut down; " |
| "automatic recovery in progress"))); |
| if (recoveryTargetTLI > ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("crash recovery starts in timeline %u " |
| "and has target timeline %u", |
| ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID, |
| recoveryTargetTLI))); |
| ControlFile->state = DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPointLoc; |
| ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint; |
| if (InArchiveRecovery) |
| { |
| /* initialize minRecoveryPoint if not set yet */ |
| if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < checkPoint.redo) |
| { |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = checkPoint.redo; |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Set backupStartPoint if we're starting recovery from a base backup. |
| * |
| * Also set backupEndPoint and use minRecoveryPoint as the backup end |
| * location if we're starting recovery from a base backup which was |
| * taken from a standby. In this case, the database system status in |
| * pg_control must indicate that the database was already in recovery. |
| * Usually that will be DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY but also can be |
| * DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY if recovery previously was interrupted |
| * before reaching this point; e.g. because restore_command or |
| * primary_conninfo were faulty. |
| * |
| * Any other state indicates that the backup somehow became corrupted |
| * and we can't sensibly continue with recovery. |
| */ |
| if (haveBackupLabel) |
| { |
| ControlFile->backupStartPoint = checkPoint.redo; |
| ControlFile->backupEndRequired = backupEndRequired; |
| |
| if (backupFromStandby) |
| { |
| if (dbstate_at_startup != DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY && |
| dbstate_at_startup != DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("backup_label contains data inconsistent with control file"), |
| errhint("This means that the backup is corrupted and you will " |
| "have to use another backup for recovery."))); |
| ControlFile->backupEndPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint; |
| } |
| } |
| ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| /* No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough */ |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint. When doing crash |
| * recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL. Particularly, in |
| * the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the |
| * control file is only updated after the first checkpoint. However, |
| * if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint |
| * is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the |
| * startup process to think that there are still invalid page |
| * references when checking for data consistency. |
| */ |
| if (InArchiveRecovery) |
| { |
| minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint; |
| minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| minRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| minRecoveryPointTLI = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Reset pgstat data, because it may be invalid after recovery. |
| */ |
| pgstat_reset_all(); |
| |
| /* |
| * If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info |
| * has now been propagated into pg_control. We must get rid of the |
| * label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at |
| * the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back |
| * to the backup start point. It seems prudent though to just rename |
| * the file out of the way rather than delete it completely. |
| */ |
| if (haveBackupLabel) |
| { |
| unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_OLD); |
| durable_rename(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, FATAL); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the |
| * symlinks have been created. We must get rid of the map file so |
| * that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again. |
| * It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way |
| * rather than delete it completely. |
| */ |
| if (haveTblspcMap) |
| { |
| unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD); |
| durable_rename(TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, FATAL); |
| } |
| |
| /* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */ |
| CheckRequiredParameterValues(); |
| |
| /* |
| * We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be |
| * reset. This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby |
| * connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever |
| * garbage is left over from before. |
| */ |
| ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP); |
| |
| /* |
| * Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left |
| * behind by crashed backends. |
| */ |
| DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in |
| * yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in |
| * control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a |
| * running-xacts WAL record. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && EnableHotStandby) |
| { |
| TransactionId *xids; |
| int nxids; |
| |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("initializing for hot standby"))); |
| |
| InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(); |
| |
| if (wasShutdown) |
| oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids); |
| else |
| oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid; |
| Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(oldestActiveXID)); |
| |
| /* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */ |
| ProcArrayInitRecovery(XidFromFullTransactionId(ShmemVariableCache->nextXid)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Startup subtrans only. CLOG, MultiXact and commit timestamp |
| * have already been started up and other SLRUs are not maintained |
| * during recovery and need not be started yet. |
| */ |
| StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID); |
| DistributedLog_Startup(oldestActiveXID, |
| XidFromFullTransactionId(ShmemVariableCache->nextXid)); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that |
| * nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an |
| * empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover |
| * additional standby state for prepared transactions. |
| */ |
| if (wasShutdown) |
| { |
| RunningTransactionsData running; |
| TransactionId latestCompletedXid; |
| |
| /* |
| * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a |
| * shut down server, with only prepared transactions still |
| * alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all |
| * subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions. |
| */ |
| running.xcnt = nxids; |
| running.subxcnt = 0; |
| running.subxid_overflow = false; |
| running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid); |
| running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID; |
| latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid); |
| TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid); |
| Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid)); |
| running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid; |
| running.xids = xids; |
| |
| ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running); |
| |
| StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions(); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Initialize resource managers */ |
| for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++) |
| { |
| if (RmgrTable[rmid].rm_startup != NULL) |
| RmgrTable[rmid].rm_startup(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize shared variables for tracking progress of WAL replay, as |
| * if we had just replayed the record before the REDO location (or the |
| * checkpoint record itself, if it's a shutdown checkpoint). |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| if (checkPoint.redo < RecPtr) |
| XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr = checkPoint.redo; |
| else |
| XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr = EndRecPtr; |
| XLogCtl->replayEndTLI = ThisTimeLineID; |
| XLogCtl->lastReplayedEndRecPtr = XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr; |
| XLogCtl->lastReplayedTLI = XLogCtl->replayEndTLI; |
| XLogCtl->recoveryLastXTime = 0; |
| XLogCtl->currentChunkStartTime = 0; |
| XLogCtl->recoveryPauseState = RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* Also ensure XLogReceiptTime has a sane value */ |
| XLogReceiptTime = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Let postmaster know we've started redo now, so that it can launch |
| * checkpointer to perform restartpoints. We don't bother during |
| * crash recovery as restartpoints can only be performed during |
| * archive recovery. And we'd like to keep crash recovery simple, to |
| * avoid introducing bugs that could affect you when recovering after |
| * crash. |
| * |
| * After this point, we can no longer assume that we're the only |
| * process in addition to postmaster! Also, fsync requests are |
| * subsequently to be handled by the checkpointer, not locally. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && IsUnderPostmaster) |
| { |
| PublishStartupProcessInformation(); |
| EnableSyncRequestForwarding(); |
| SendPostmasterSignal(PMSIGNAL_RECOVERY_STARTED); |
| bgwriterLaunched = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Allow read-only connections immediately if we're consistent |
| * already. |
| */ |
| CheckRecoveryConsistency(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Find the first record that logically follows the checkpoint --- it |
| * might physically precede it, though. |
| */ |
| if (checkPoint.redo < RecPtr) |
| { |
| /* back up to find the record */ |
| XLogBeginRead(xlogreader, checkPoint.redo); |
| record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, PANIC, false); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* just have to read next record after CheckPoint */ |
| record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, LOG, false); |
| } |
| |
| if (record != NULL) |
| { |
| ErrorContextCallback errcallback; |
| TimestampTz xtime; |
| PGRUsage ru0; |
| |
| pg_rusage_init(&ru0); |
| |
| InRedo = true; |
| |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("redo starts at %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ReadRecPtr)))); |
| |
| /* |
| * main redo apply loop |
| */ |
| do |
| { |
| bool switchedTLI = false; |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| if (XLOG_DEBUG || |
| (rmid == RM_XACT_ID && trace_recovery_messages <= DEBUG2) || |
| (rmid != RM_XACT_ID && trace_recovery_messages <= DEBUG3)) |
| { |
| StringInfoData buf; |
| |
| initStringInfo(&buf); |
| appendStringInfo(&buf, "REDO @ %X/%X; LSN %X/%X: ", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ReadRecPtr), |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndRecPtr)); |
| xlog_outrec(&buf, xlogreader); |
| appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - "); |
| xlog_outdesc(&buf, xlogreader); |
| elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data); |
| pfree(buf.data); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| /* Handle interrupt signals of startup process */ |
| HandleStartupProcInterrupts(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Pause WAL replay, if requested by a hot-standby session via |
| * SetRecoveryPause(). |
| * |
| * Note that we intentionally don't take the info_lck spinlock |
| * here. We might therefore read a slightly stale value of |
| * the recoveryPause flag, but it can't be very stale (no |
| * worse than the last spinlock we did acquire). Since a |
| * pause request is a pretty asynchronous thing anyway, |
| * possibly responding to it one WAL record later than we |
| * otherwise would is a minor issue, so it doesn't seem worth |
| * adding another spinlock cycle to prevent that. |
| */ |
| if (((volatile XLogCtlData *) XLogCtl)->recoveryPauseState != |
| RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED) |
| recoveryPausesHere(false); |
| |
| /* |
| * Have we reached our recovery target? |
| */ |
| if (recoveryStopsBefore(xlogreader)) |
| { |
| reachedRecoveryTarget = true; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If we've been asked to lag the primary, wait on latch until |
| * enough time has passed. |
| */ |
| if (recoveryApplyDelay(xlogreader)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We test for paused recovery again here. If user sets |
| * delayed apply, it may be because they expect to pause |
| * recovery in case of problems, so we must test again |
| * here otherwise pausing during the delay-wait wouldn't |
| * work. |
| */ |
| if (((volatile XLogCtlData *) XLogCtl)->recoveryPauseState != |
| RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED) |
| recoveryPausesHere(false); |
| } |
| |
| /* Setup error traceback support for ereport() */ |
| errcallback.callback = rm_redo_error_callback; |
| errcallback.arg = (void *) xlogreader; |
| errcallback.previous = error_context_stack; |
| error_context_stack = &errcallback; |
| |
| /* |
| * ShmemVariableCache->nextXid must be beyond record's xid. |
| */ |
| AdvanceNextFullTransactionIdPastXid(record->xl_xid); |
| |
| /* |
| * Before replaying this record, check if this record causes |
| * the current timeline to change. The record is already |
| * considered to be part of the new timeline, so we update |
| * ThisTimeLineID before replaying it. That's important so |
| * that replayEndTLI, which is recorded as the minimum |
| * recovery point's TLI if recovery stops after this record, |
| * is set correctly. |
| */ |
| if (record->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID) |
| { |
| TimeLineID newTLI = ThisTimeLineID; |
| TimeLineID prevTLI = ThisTimeLineID; |
| uint8 info = record->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK; |
| |
| if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN) |
| { |
| CheckPoint checkPoint; |
| |
| memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(xlogreader), sizeof(CheckPoint)); |
| newTLI = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID; |
| prevTLI = checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID; |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY) |
| { |
| xl_end_of_recovery xlrec; |
| |
| memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(xlogreader), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery)); |
| newTLI = xlrec.ThisTimeLineID; |
| prevTLI = xlrec.PrevTimeLineID; |
| } |
| |
| if (newTLI != ThisTimeLineID) |
| { |
| /* Check that it's OK to switch to this TLI */ |
| checkTimeLineSwitch(EndRecPtr, newTLI, prevTLI); |
| |
| /* Following WAL records should be run with new TLI */ |
| ThisTimeLineID = newTLI; |
| switchedTLI = true; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Update shared replayEndRecPtr before replaying this record, |
| * so that XLogFlush will update minRecoveryPoint correctly. |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->replayEndRecPtr = EndRecPtr; |
| XLogCtl->replayEndTLI = ThisTimeLineID; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we are attempting to enter Hot Standby mode, process |
| * XIDs we see |
| */ |
| if (standbyState >= STANDBY_INITIALIZED && |
| TransactionIdIsValid(record->xl_xid)) |
| RecordKnownAssignedTransactionIds(record->xl_xid); |
| |
| /* Now apply the WAL record itself */ |
| RmgrTable[record->xl_rmid].rm_redo(xlogreader); |
| |
| /* |
| * After redo, check whether the backup pages associated with |
| * the WAL record are consistent with the existing pages. This |
| * check is done only if consistency check is enabled for this |
| * record. |
| */ |
| if ((record->xl_info & XLR_CHECK_CONSISTENCY) != 0) |
| checkXLogConsistency(xlogreader); |
| |
| /* Pop the error context stack */ |
| error_context_stack = errcallback.previous; |
| |
| /* |
| * Update lastReplayedEndRecPtr after this record has been |
| * successfully replayed. |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->lastReplayedEndRecPtr = EndRecPtr; |
| XLogCtl->lastReplayedTLI = ThisTimeLineID; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| if (create_restartpoint_on_ckpt_record_replay && ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Create restartpoint on checkpoint record if requested. |
| * |
| * The bgwriter creates restartpoints during archive |
| * recovery at its own leisure. But gp_replica_check fails |
| * with this, because it bypasses the shared buffer cache |
| * and reads directly from disk. So, via GUC it can |
| * request to force creating restart point mainly to flush |
| * the shared buffers to disk. |
| */ |
| uint8 xlogRecInfo = record->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK; |
| |
| if (record->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID && |
| (xlogRecInfo == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN || |
| xlogRecInfo == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)) |
| { |
| if (bgwriterLaunched) |
| RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE | CHECKPOINT_WAIT); |
| else |
| elog(LOG, "Skipping CreateRestartPoint() as bgwriter is not launched."); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If rm_redo called XLogRequestWalReceiverReply, then we wake |
| * up the receiver so that it notices the updated |
| * lastReplayedEndRecPtr and sends a reply to the primary. |
| */ |
| if (doRequestWalReceiverReply) |
| { |
| doRequestWalReceiverReply = false; |
| WalRcvForceReply(); |
| } |
| |
| /* Remember this record as the last-applied one */ |
| LastRec = ReadRecPtr; |
| |
| /* Allow read-only connections if we're consistent now */ |
| CheckRecoveryConsistency(); |
| |
| /* Is this a timeline switch? */ |
| if (switchedTLI) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Before we continue on the new timeline, clean up any |
| * (possibly bogus) future WAL segments on the old |
| * timeline. |
| */ |
| RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(EndRecPtr, ThisTimeLineID); |
| |
| /* |
| * Wake up any walsenders to notice that we are on a new |
| * timeline. |
| */ |
| if (AllowCascadeReplication()) |
| WalSndWakeup(); |
| } |
| |
| if (gp_pause_on_restore_point_replay) |
| pauseRecoveryOnRestorePoint(xlogreader); |
| |
| /* Exit the recovery loop if a promotion is triggered in pauseRecoveryOnRestorePoint() */ |
| if (reachedContinuousRecoveryTarget && recoveryTargetAction == RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PROMOTE){ |
| reachedRecoveryTarget = true; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* Exit loop if we reached inclusive recovery target */ |
| if (recoveryStopsAfter(xlogreader)) |
| { |
| reachedRecoveryTarget = true; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* Else, try to fetch the next WAL record */ |
| record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, LOG, false); |
| } while (record != NULL); |
| |
| /* |
| * end of main redo apply loop |
| */ |
| |
| if (reachedRecoveryTarget) |
| { |
| if (!reachedConsistency) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("requested recovery stop point is before consistent recovery point"))); |
| |
| /* |
| * This is the last point where we can restart recovery with a |
| * new recovery target, if we shutdown and begin again. After |
| * this, Resource Managers may choose to do permanent |
| * corrective actions at end of recovery. |
| */ |
| switch (recoveryTargetAction) |
| { |
| case RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_SHUTDOWN: |
| |
| /* |
| * exit with special return code to request shutdown |
| * of postmaster. Log messages issued from |
| * postmaster. |
| */ |
| proc_exit(3); |
| |
| case RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PAUSE: |
| SetRecoveryPause(true); |
| recoveryPausesHere(true); |
| |
| /* drop into promote */ |
| |
| case RECOVERY_TARGET_ACTION_PROMOTE: |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Allow resource managers to do any required cleanup. */ |
| for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++) |
| { |
| if (RmgrTable[rmid].rm_cleanup != NULL) |
| RmgrTable[rmid].rm_cleanup(); |
| } |
| |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("redo done at %X/%X system usage: %s", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ReadRecPtr), |
| pg_rusage_show(&ru0)))); |
| xtime = GetLatestXTime(); |
| if (xtime) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("last completed transaction was at log time %s", |
| timestamptz_to_str(xtime)))); |
| |
| InRedo = false; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* there are no WAL records following the checkpoint */ |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("redo is not required"))); |
| |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * This check is intentionally after the above log messages that |
| * indicate how far recovery went. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && |
| recoveryTarget != RECOVERY_TARGET_UNSET && |
| !reachedRecoveryTarget) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("recovery ended before configured recovery target was reached"))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Kill WAL receiver, if it's still running, before we continue to write |
| * the startup checkpoint and aborted-contrecord records. It will trump |
| * over these records and subsequent ones if it's still alive when we |
| * start writing WAL. |
| */ |
| ShutdownWalRcv(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is |
| * done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations |
| * created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having |
| * completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post |
| * end-of-recovery steps fail. |
| */ |
| if (InRecovery) |
| ResetUnloggedRelations(UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT); |
| |
| /* |
| * We don't need the latch anymore. It's not strictly necessary to disown |
| * it, but let's do it for the sake of tidiness. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| DisownLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch); |
| |
| /* |
| * We are now done reading the xlog from stream. Turn off streaming |
| * recovery to force fetching the files (which would be required at end of |
| * recovery, e.g., timeline history file) from archive or pg_wal. |
| * |
| * Note that standby mode must be turned off after killing WAL receiver, |
| * i.e., calling ShutdownWalRcv(). |
| */ |
| Assert(!WalRcvStreaming()); |
| StandbyMode = false; |
| |
| /* |
| * Determine where to start writing WAL next. |
| * |
| * When recovery ended in an incomplete record, write a WAL record about |
| * that and continue after it. In all other cases, re-fetch the last |
| * valid or last applied record, so we can identify the exact endpoint of |
| * what we consider the valid portion of WAL. |
| */ |
| XLogBeginRead(xlogreader, LastRec); |
| record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, PANIC, false); |
| EndOfLog = EndRecPtr; |
| |
| /* |
| * EndOfLogTLI is the TLI in the filename of the XLOG segment containing |
| * the end-of-log. It could be different from the timeline that EndOfLog |
| * nominally belongs to, if there was a timeline switch in that segment, |
| * and we were reading the old WAL from a segment belonging to a higher |
| * timeline. |
| */ |
| EndOfLogTLI = xlogreader->seg.ws_tli; |
| |
| if (IsNormalProcessingMode()) |
| elog(LOG,"end of transaction log location is %X/%X", |
| (uint32) (EndOfLog >> 32), (uint32) EndOfLog); |
| |
| /* |
| * Complain if we did not roll forward far enough to render the backup |
| * dump consistent. Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable |
| * minRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint might |
| * be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have been |
| * advanced beyond the WAL we processed. |
| */ |
| if (InRecovery && |
| (EndOfLog < minRecoveryPoint || |
| !XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint))) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or |
| * minRecoveryPoint. That's usually a bad sign, indicating that you |
| * tried to recover from an online backup but never called |
| * pg_stop_backup(), or you didn't archive all the WAL up to that |
| * point. However, this also happens in crash recovery, if the system |
| * crashes while an online backup is in progress. We must not treat |
| * that as an error, or the database will refuse to start up. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested || ControlFile->backupEndRequired) |
| { |
| if (ControlFile->backupEndRequired) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"), |
| errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery."))); |
| else if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"), |
| errhint("Online backup started with pg_start_backup() must be ended with pg_stop_backup(), and all WAL up to that point must be available at recovery."))); |
| else |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point"))); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present. |
| * This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so |
| * as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done. |
| */ |
| oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(NULL, NULL); |
| |
| /* |
| * Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID. |
| * |
| * If we are doing an archive recovery, we always assign a new ID. This |
| * handles a couple of issues. If we stopped short of the end of WAL |
| * during recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must |
| * assign it a unique new ID. Even if we ran to the end, modifying the |
| * current last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to |
| * overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage |
| * DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that. We can dodge the |
| * problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID. |
| * |
| * In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in. |
| */ |
| PrevTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID; |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| { |
| char reason[200]; |
| char recoveryPath[MAXPGPATH]; |
| |
| Assert(InArchiveRecovery); |
| |
| ThisTimeLineID = findNewestTimeLine(recoveryTargetTLI) + 1; |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", ThisTimeLineID))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Create a comment for the history file to explain why and where |
| * timeline changed. |
| */ |
| if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_XID) |
| snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason), |
| "%s transaction %u", |
| recoveryStopAfter ? "after" : "before", |
| recoveryStopXid); |
| else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIME) |
| snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason), |
| "%s %s\n", |
| recoveryStopAfter ? "after" : "before", |
| timestamptz_to_str(recoveryStopTime)); |
| else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_LSN) |
| snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason), |
| "%s LSN %X/%X\n", |
| recoveryStopAfter ? "after" : "before", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(recoveryStopLSN)); |
| else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_NAME) |
| snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason), |
| "at restore point \"%s\"", |
| recoveryStopName); |
| else if (recoveryTarget == RECOVERY_TARGET_IMMEDIATE) |
| snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason), "reached consistency"); |
| else |
| snprintf(reason, sizeof(reason), "no recovery target specified"); |
| |
| /* |
| * We are now done reading the old WAL. Turn off archive fetching if |
| * it was active, and make a writable copy of the last WAL segment. |
| * (Note that we also have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in |
| * readBuf; we will use that below.) |
| */ |
| exitArchiveRecovery(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog); |
| |
| /* |
| * Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this |
| * point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline |
| * will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby |
| * servers. If we crash before actually switching to the new |
| * timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched |
| * to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline. |
| * To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible |
| * between here and writing the end-of-recovery record. |
| */ |
| writeTimeLineHistory(ThisTimeLineID, recoveryTargetTLI, |
| EndRecPtr, reason); |
| |
| /* |
| * Since there might be a partial WAL segment named RECOVERYXLOG, get |
| * rid of it. |
| */ |
| snprintf(recoveryPath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/RECOVERYXLOG"); |
| unlink(recoveryPath); /* ignore any error */ |
| |
| /* Get rid of any remaining recovered timeline-history file, too */ |
| snprintf(recoveryPath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/RECOVERYHISTORY"); |
| unlink(recoveryPath); /* ignore any error */ |
| } |
| |
| /* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */ |
| XLogCtl->ThisTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID; |
| XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID = PrevTimeLineID; |
| |
| /* |
| * Actually, if WAL ended in an incomplete record, skip the parts that |
| * made it through and start writing after the portion that persisted. |
| * (It's critical to first write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message, which |
| * we'll do as soon as we're open for writing new WAL.) |
| */ |
| if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(missingContrecPtr)) |
| { |
| Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(abortedRecPtr)); |
| EndOfLog = missingContrecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog |
| * buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the |
| * previous incarnation. |
| */ |
| Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| Insert->PrevBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(LastRec); |
| Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog); |
| |
| /* |
| * Tricky point here: readBuf contains the *last* block that the LastRec |
| * record spans, not the one it starts in. The last block is indeed the |
| * one we want to use. |
| */ |
| if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0) |
| { |
| char *page; |
| int len; |
| int firstIdx; |
| XLogRecPtr pageBeginPtr; |
| |
| pageBeginPtr = EndOfLog - (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ); |
| Assert(readOff == XLogSegmentOffset(pageBeginPtr, wal_segment_size)); |
| |
| firstIdx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(EndOfLog); |
| |
| /* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */ |
| page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ]; |
| len = EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| memcpy(page, xlogreader->readBuf, len); |
| memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len); |
| |
| XLogCtl->xlblocks[firstIdx] = pageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = pageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and |
| * let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next |
| * buffer. |
| */ |
| XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = EndOfLog; |
| } |
| |
| LogwrtResult.Write = LogwrtResult.Flush = EndOfLog; |
| |
| XLogCtl->LogwrtResult = LogwrtResult; |
| |
| XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndOfLog; |
| XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = EndOfLog; |
| |
| LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(); |
| |
| /* If necessary, write overwrite-contrecord before doing anything else */ |
| if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(abortedRecPtr)) |
| { |
| Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(missingContrecPtr)); |
| CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(abortedRecPtr); |
| abortedRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| missingContrecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE |
| * record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint |
| * record is written. |
| */ |
| Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites; |
| UpdateFullPageWrites(); |
| LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1; |
| |
| if (InRecovery) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk. |
| * |
| * Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line |
| * one. This is not particularly critical, but since we may be |
| * assigning a new TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have |
| * the rule that TLI only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which |
| * allows some extra error checking in xlog_redo. |
| * |
| * In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record |
| * instead of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later, |
| * after we're fully out of recovery mode and already accepting |
| * queries. |
| */ |
| if (bgwriterLaunched) |
| { |
| if (LocalPromoteIsTriggered) |
| { |
| checkPointLoc = ControlFile->checkPoint; |
| |
| /* |
| * Confirm the last checkpoint is available for us to recover |
| * from if we fail. |
| */ |
| record = ReadCheckpointRecord(xlogreader, checkPointLoc, 1, false); |
| if (record != NULL) |
| { |
| promoted = true; |
| |
| /* |
| * Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of |
| * recovery, since we aren't doing a checkpoint. That |
| * means that the checkpointer process may likely be in |
| * the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and could |
| * continue to be for minutes after this. That sounds |
| * strange, but the effect is roughly the same and it |
| * would be stranger to try to come out of the |
| * restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a |
| * checkpoint later anyway, just for safety. |
| */ |
| CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (!promoted) |
| RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY | |
| CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE | |
| CHECKPOINT_WAIT); |
| } |
| else |
| CreateCheckPoint(CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY | CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Preallocate additional log files, if wanted. |
| */ |
| PreallocXlogFiles(EndOfLog); |
| |
| /* |
| * Okay, we're officially UP. |
| */ |
| InRecovery = false; |
| |
| SIMPLE_FAULT_INJECTOR("out_of_recovery_in_startupxlog"); |
| |
| /* |
| * Hook for plugins to do additional startup works. |
| * |
| * Allow to write any WALs in hook. |
| */ |
| if (Startup_hook) |
| { |
| LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(); |
| (*Startup_hook) (); |
| LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1; |
| } |
| |
| /* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */ |
| XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = EndOfLog; |
| |
| /* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */ |
| LWLockAcquire(ProcArrayLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ShmemVariableCache->latestCompletedXid = ShmemVariableCache->nextXid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->latestCompletedGxid = ShmemVariableCache->nextGxid; |
| FullTransactionIdRetreat(&ShmemVariableCache->latestCompletedXid); |
| if (IsNormalProcessingMode()) |
| elog(LOG, "latest completed transaction id is %u and next transaction id is %u", |
| XidFromFullTransactionId(ShmemVariableCache->latestCompletedXid), |
| XidFromFullTransactionId(ShmemVariableCache->nextXid)); |
| LWLockRelease(ProcArrayLock); |
| |
| /* |
| * Start up subtrans, if not already done for hot standby. (commit |
| * timestamps are started below, if necessary.) |
| */ |
| if (standbyState == STANDBY_DISABLED) |
| { |
| StartupCLOG(); |
| StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID); |
| DistributedLog_Startup(oldestActiveXID, |
| XidFromFullTransactionId(ShmemVariableCache->nextXid)); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it. |
| */ |
| TrimCLOG(); |
| TrimMultiXact(); |
| |
| /* Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions */ |
| RecoverPreparedTransactions(); |
| |
| /* Shut down xlogreader */ |
| if (readFile >= 0) |
| { |
| close(readFile); |
| readFile = -1; |
| } |
| XLogReaderFree(xlogreader); |
| |
| /* |
| * If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow |
| * backends to write WAL. |
| */ |
| LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(); |
| XLogReportParameters(); |
| |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested) |
| { |
| /* |
| * And finally, execute the recovery_end_command, if any. |
| */ |
| if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0) |
| ExecuteRecoveryCommand(recoveryEndCommand, |
| "recovery_end_command", |
| true); |
| |
| /* |
| * We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old |
| * timeline. |
| * |
| * If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline, |
| * remove them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be |
| * pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not |
| * part of the new timeline's history so we don't need them. |
| */ |
| RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(EndOfLog, ThisTimeLineID); |
| |
| /* |
| * If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with |
| * the last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive |
| * it, and the server that created the WAL never archives it either |
| * (e.g. because it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the |
| * archive. That's OK from our point of view, because the new segment |
| * that we created with the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old |
| * timeline up to the switch point. But if you later try to do PITR to |
| * the "missing" WAL on the old timeline, recovery won't find it in |
| * the archive. It's physically present in the new file with new TLI, |
| * but recovery won't look there when it's recovering to the older |
| * timeline. On the other hand, if we archive the partial segment, and |
| * the original server on that timeline is still running and archives |
| * the completed version of the same segment later, it will fail. (We |
| * used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it caused such problems). |
| * |
| * As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial |
| * suffix, and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read |
| * .partial segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd |
| * PITR case, the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal |
| * directory (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging, |
| * too. |
| * |
| * If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline, |
| * however, we had already determined that the segment is complete, so |
| * we can let it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was |
| * restored from the archive to begin with, it's expected to have a |
| * .done file). |
| */ |
| if (XLogSegmentOffset(EndOfLog, wal_segment_size) != 0 && |
| XLogArchivingActive()) |
| { |
| char origfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| XLogSegNo endLogSegNo; |
| |
| XLByteToPrevSeg(EndOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| XLogFileName(origfname, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| if (!XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(origfname)) |
| { |
| char origpath[MAXPGPATH]; |
| char partialfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| char partialpath[MAXPGPATH]; |
| |
| XLogFilePath(origpath, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname); |
| snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath); |
| |
| /* |
| * Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial |
| * file. |
| */ |
| XLogArchiveCleanup(partialfname); |
| |
| durable_rename(origpath, partialpath, ERROR); |
| XLogArchiveNotify(partialfname); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If we are a standby with contentid -1 and undergoing promotion, |
| * update ourselves as the new master in catalog. This does not |
| * apply to a mirror (standby of a GPDB segment) because it is |
| * managed by FTS. |
| */ |
| bool needToPromoteCatalog = (IS_QUERY_DISPATCHER() && |
| ControlFile->state == DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY); |
| |
| if(IsNormalProcessingMode()) |
| ereport(LOG, (errmsg("database system is ready"))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of |
| * commit timestamp. |
| */ |
| CompleteCommitTsInitialization(); |
| |
| /* |
| * All done with end-of-recovery actions. |
| * |
| * Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in |
| * consequence. SharedRecoveryState, that controls if backends can write |
| * WAL, is updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends |
| * to look at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory. |
| * There is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and |
| * the control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION |
| * state while looking at the on-disk control file. |
| * |
| * Also, we use info_lck to update SharedRecoveryState to ensure that |
| * there are no race conditions concerning visibility of other recent |
| * updates to shared memory. |
| */ |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ControlFile->state = DB_IN_PRODUCTION; |
| ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState = RECOVERY_STATE_DONE; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| /* |
| * Shutdown the recovery environment. This must occur after |
| * RecoverPreparedTransactions() (see notes in lock_twophase_recover()) |
| * and after switching SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE so as |
| * any session building a snapshot will not rely on KnownAssignedXids as |
| * RecoveryInProgress() would return false at this stage. This is |
| * particularly critical for prepared 2PC transactions, that would still |
| * need to be included in snapshots once recovery has ended. |
| */ |
| if (standbyState != STANDBY_DISABLED) |
| ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(); |
| |
| /* |
| * GPDB: A timeline history file is only marked as ready for archival if |
| * WAL archiving was already enabled when a new timeline id is created |
| * during promotion. Thus it's possible to get into a state where the |
| * timeline history file is not archived yet due to WAL archiving being |
| * disabled during the timeline switch. As such, we need to guarantee |
| * that the current timeline history file is archived. This will make |
| * sure downstream operations that require the timeline history file |
| * succeed (e.g. creating a standby with recovery_target_timeline |
| * explicitly set to the control file's timeline id or when creating a |
| * streaming replication standby). Skip if the current timeline ID is 1 |
| * since there's no timeline history file for it. |
| */ |
| if (XLogArchivingActive() && ThisTimeLineID > 1) |
| { |
| char histfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| |
| TLHistoryFileName(histfname, ThisTimeLineID); |
| |
| /* |
| * Timeline history .done files do not get removed automatically so |
| * this check should be valid to make sure we don't archive the |
| * timeline history file again on restart. However, if the timeline |
| * history .done file was manually removed for some reason, then we |
| * make the assumption that the archive_command is set up properly to |
| * gracefully handle the re-archiving attempt. |
| */ |
| if (!XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(histfname)) |
| XLogArchiveNotify(histfname); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal |
| * sender processes to notice that we've been promoted. |
| */ |
| WalSndWakeup(); |
| |
| |
| /* |
| * Now we can update the catalog to tell the system is fully-promoted, |
| * if was standby. This should be done after all WAL-replay finished |
| * otherwise we'll be in inconsistent state where catalog says I'm in |
| * primary state while the recovery is trying to stream. |
| */ |
| if (needToPromoteCatalog) |
| UpdateCatalogForStandbyPromotion(); |
| |
| /* |
| * If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This isn't |
| * required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far back, |
| * and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer than is |
| * appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore. |
| */ |
| if (promoted) |
| RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE); |
| |
| if (Gp_role == GP_ROLE_DISPATCH) |
| *shmCleanupBackends = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Checks if recovery has reached a consistent state. When consistency is |
| * reached and we have a valid starting standby snapshot, tell postmaster |
| * that it can start accepting read-only connections. |
| */ |
| static void |
| CheckRecoveryConsistency(void) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr lastReplayedEndRecPtr; |
| |
| /* |
| * During crash recovery, we don't reach a consistent state until we've |
| * replayed all the WAL. |
| */ |
| if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint)) |
| return; |
| |
| Assert(InArchiveRecovery); |
| |
| /* |
| * assume that we are called in the startup process, and hence don't need |
| * a lock to read lastReplayedEndRecPtr |
| */ |
| lastReplayedEndRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastReplayedEndRecPtr; |
| |
| /* |
| * Have we reached the point where our base backup was completed? |
| */ |
| if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupEndPoint) && |
| ControlFile->backupEndPoint <= lastReplayedEndRecPtr) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control. |
| * The data on disk is now consistent. Reset backupStartPoint and |
| * backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to make sure we don't |
| * allow starting up at an earlier point even if recovery is stopped |
| * and restarted soon after this. |
| */ |
| elog(DEBUG1, "end of backup reached"); |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| |
| if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastReplayedEndRecPtr) |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastReplayedEndRecPtr; |
| |
| ControlFile->backupStartPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| ControlFile->backupEndPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| ControlFile->backupEndRequired = false; |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Have we passed our safe starting point? Note that minRecoveryPoint is |
| * known to be incorrectly set if ControlFile->backupEndRequired, until |
| * the XLOG_BACKUP_END arrives to advise us of the correct |
| * minRecoveryPoint. All we know prior to that is that we're not |
| * consistent yet. |
| */ |
| if (!reachedConsistency && !ControlFile->backupEndRequired && |
| minRecoveryPoint <= lastReplayedEndRecPtr && |
| XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Check to see if the XLOG sequence contained any unresolved |
| * references to uninitialized pages. |
| */ |
| XLogCheckInvalidPages(); |
| |
| if (xlog_check_consistency_hook) { |
| xlog_check_consistency_hook(); |
| } |
| |
| reachedConsistency = true; |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("consistent recovery state reached at %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastReplayedEndRecPtr)))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Have we got a valid starting snapshot that will allow queries to be |
| * run? If so, we can tell postmaster that the database is consistent now, |
| * enabling connections. |
| */ |
| if (standbyState == STANDBY_SNAPSHOT_READY && |
| !LocalHotStandbyActive && |
| reachedConsistency && |
| IsUnderPostmaster) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->SharedHotStandbyActive = true; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| LocalHotStandbyActive = true; |
| |
| SendPostmasterSignal(PMSIGNAL_BEGIN_HOT_STANDBY); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Is the system still in recovery? |
| * |
| * Unlike testing InRecovery, this works in any process that's connected to |
| * shared memory. |
| * |
| * As a side-effect, we initialize the local TimeLineID and RedoRecPtr |
| * variables the first time we see that recovery is finished. |
| */ |
| bool |
| RecoveryInProgress(void) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We |
| * can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the |
| * shared variable has once been seen false. |
| */ |
| if (!LocalRecoveryInProgress) |
| return false; |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the |
| * shared variable. |
| */ |
| volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl; |
| |
| LocalRecoveryInProgress = (xlogctl->SharedRecoveryState != RECOVERY_STATE_DONE); |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize TimeLineID and RedoRecPtr when we discover that recovery |
| * is finished. InitPostgres() relies upon this behaviour to ensure |
| * that InitXLOGAccess() is called at backend startup. (If you change |
| * this, see also LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed.) |
| */ |
| if (!LocalRecoveryInProgress) |
| { |
| /* |
| * If we just exited recovery, make sure we read TimeLineID and |
| * RedoRecPtr after SharedRecoveryState (for machines with weak |
| * memory ordering). |
| */ |
| pg_memory_barrier(); |
| InitXLOGAccess(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery. |
| * We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller |
| * can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway. |
| */ |
| |
| return LocalRecoveryInProgress; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns current recovery state from shared memory. |
| * |
| * This returned state is kept consistent with the contents of the control |
| * file. See details about the possible values of RecoveryState in xlog.h. |
| */ |
| RecoveryState |
| GetRecoveryState(void) |
| { |
| RecoveryState retval; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Is HotStandby active yet? This is only important in special backends |
| * since normal backends won't ever be able to connect until this returns |
| * true. Postmaster knows this by way of signal, not via shared memory. |
| * |
| * Unlike testing standbyState, this works in any process that's connected to |
| * shared memory. (And note that standbyState alone doesn't tell the truth |
| * anyway.) |
| */ |
| bool |
| HotStandbyActive(void) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We check shared state each time only until Hot Standby is active. We |
| * can't de-activate Hot Standby, so there's no need to keep checking |
| * after the shared variable has once been seen true. |
| */ |
| if (LocalHotStandbyActive) |
| return true; |
| else |
| { |
| /* spinlock is essential on machines with weak memory ordering! */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| LocalHotStandbyActive = XLogCtl->SharedHotStandbyActive; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return LocalHotStandbyActive; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Like HotStandbyActive(), but to be used only in WAL replay code, |
| * where we don't need to ask any other process what the state is. |
| */ |
| bool |
| HotStandbyActiveInReplay(void) |
| { |
| Assert(AmStartupProcess() || !IsPostmasterEnvironment); |
| return LocalHotStandbyActive; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Is this process allowed to insert new WAL records? |
| * |
| * Ordinarily this is essentially equivalent to !RecoveryInProgress(). |
| * But we also have provisions for forcing the result "true" or "false" |
| * within specific processes regardless of the global state. |
| */ |
| bool |
| XLogInsertAllowed(void) |
| { |
| /* |
| * If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just |
| * return it. This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known |
| * done. |
| */ |
| if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0) |
| return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed; |
| |
| /* |
| * Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery. |
| */ |
| if (RecoveryInProgress()) |
| return false; |
| |
| /* |
| * On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is |
| * no need to keep checking. |
| */ |
| LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1; |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Make XLogInsertAllowed() return true in the current process only. |
| * |
| * Note: it is allowed to switch LocalXLogInsertAllowed back to -1 later, |
| * and even call LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed() again after that. |
| */ |
| static void |
| LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void) |
| { |
| Assert(LocalXLogInsertAllowed == -1); |
| LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 1; |
| |
| /* Initialize as RecoveryInProgress() would do when switching state */ |
| InitXLOGAccess(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Subroutine to try to fetch and validate a prior checkpoint record. |
| * |
| * whichChkpt identifies the checkpoint (merely for reporting purposes). |
| * 1 for "primary", 0 for "other" (backup_label) |
| */ |
| static XLogRecord * |
| ReadCheckpointRecord(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, XLogRecPtr RecPtr, |
| int whichChkpt, bool report) |
| { |
| XLogRecord *record; |
| uint8 info; |
| bool sizeOk; |
| uint32 chkpt_len; |
| uint32 chkpt_hdr_len_short; |
| uint32 chkpt_hdr_len_long; |
| bool length_match; |
| |
| if (!XRecOffIsValid(RecPtr)) |
| { |
| if (!report) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| switch (whichChkpt) |
| { |
| case 1: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid primary checkpoint link in control file"))); |
| break; |
| default: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid checkpoint link in backup_label file"))); |
| break; |
| } |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| XLogBeginRead(xlogreader, RecPtr); |
| record = ReadRecord(xlogreader, LOG, true); |
| |
| if (record == NULL) |
| { |
| if (!report) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| switch (whichChkpt) |
| { |
| case 1: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid primary checkpoint record at location %X/%X", |
| (uint32) (RecPtr >> 32), (uint32) RecPtr))); |
| break; |
| default: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid checkpoint record at location %X/%X", |
| (uint32) (RecPtr >> 32), (uint32) RecPtr))); |
| break; |
| } |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| if (record->xl_rmid != RM_XLOG_ID) |
| { |
| switch (whichChkpt) |
| { |
| case 1: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid resource manager ID in primary checkpoint record at location %X/%X", |
| (uint32) (RecPtr >> 32), (uint32) RecPtr))); |
| break; |
| default: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid resource manager ID in checkpoint record"))); |
| break; |
| } |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| info = record->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK; |
| if (info != XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN && |
| info != XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE) |
| { |
| switch (whichChkpt) |
| { |
| case 1: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid xl_info in primary checkpoint record"))); |
| break; |
| default: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid xl_info in checkpoint record at location %X/%X", |
| (uint32) (RecPtr >> 32), (uint32) RecPtr))); |
| break; |
| } |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * GPDB: Verify the Checkpoint record length. For an extended Checkpoint |
| * record (when record total length is greater than regular checkpoint |
| * record total length, e.g. in the case of containing DTX info), compare |
| * the difference between the regular checkpoint size and the extended |
| * variable size. |
| */ |
| sizeOk = false; |
| chkpt_len = XLogRecGetDataLen(xlogreader); |
| chkpt_hdr_len_short = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(CheckPoint); |
| chkpt_hdr_len_long = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderLong + sizeof(CheckPoint); |
| |
| if (chkpt_len > 255) /* for XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_LONG */ |
| length_match = ((chkpt_len - sizeof(CheckPoint)) == (record->xl_tot_len - chkpt_hdr_len_long)); |
| else /* for XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT */ |
| length_match = ((chkpt_len - sizeof(CheckPoint)) == (record->xl_tot_len - chkpt_hdr_len_short)); |
| |
| if ((chkpt_len == sizeof(CheckPoint) && record->xl_tot_len == chkpt_hdr_len_short) || |
| ((chkpt_len > sizeof(CheckPoint) && |
| record->xl_tot_len > chkpt_hdr_len_short && |
| length_match))) |
| sizeOk = true; |
| |
| if (!sizeOk) |
| { |
| switch (whichChkpt) |
| { |
| case 1: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid length of primary checkpoint record"))); |
| break; |
| default: |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("invalid length of checkpoint record at location %X/%X", |
| (uint32) (RecPtr >> 32), (uint32) RecPtr))); |
| break; |
| } |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * We should be wary of conflating "report" parameter. It is currently |
| * always true when we want to process the extended checkpoint record. |
| * For now this seems fine as it avoids a diff with postgres. |
| * |
| * The coordinator may execute write DTX during gpexpand, so the newly |
| * added segment may contain DTX info in checkpoint XLOG. However, this step |
| * is useless and should be avoided for segments, or fatal may be thrown since |
| * max_tm_gxacts is 0 in segments. |
| */ |
| if (report && IS_QUERY_DISPATCHER()) |
| { |
| CheckpointExtendedRecord ckptExtended; |
| UnpackCheckPointRecord(xlogreader, &ckptExtended); |
| |
| /* |
| * Find Xacts that are distributed committed from the checkpoint record and |
| * store them such that they can utilized later during DTM recovery. |
| */ |
| XLogProcessCheckpointRecord(xlogreader); |
| } |
| |
| return record; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * This must be called in a backend process before creating WAL records |
| * (except in a standalone backend, which does StartupXLOG instead). We need |
| * to initialize the local copies of ThisTimeLineID and RedoRecPtr. |
| * |
| * Note: before Postgres 8.0, we went to some effort to keep the postmaster |
| * process's copies of ThisTimeLineID and RedoRecPtr valid too. This was |
| * unnecessary however, since the postmaster itself never touches XLOG anyway. |
| */ |
| void |
| InitXLOGAccess(void) |
| { |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| |
| /* ThisTimeLineID doesn't change so we need no lock to copy it */ |
| ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->ThisTimeLineID; |
| Assert(ThisTimeLineID != 0 || IsBootstrapProcessingMode()); |
| |
| /* set wal_segment_size */ |
| wal_segment_size = ControlFile->xlog_seg_size; |
| |
| /* Use GetRedoRecPtr to copy the RedoRecPtr safely */ |
| (void) GetRedoRecPtr(); |
| /* Also update our copy of doPageWrites. */ |
| doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->forcePageWrites); |
| |
| /* Also initialize the working areas for constructing WAL records */ |
| InitXLogInsert(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the current Redo pointer from shared memory. |
| * |
| * As a side-effect, the local RedoRecPtr copy is updated. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| GetRedoRecPtr(void) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr ptr; |
| |
| /* |
| * The possibly not up-to-date copy in XlogCtl is enough. Even if we |
| * grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in |
| * Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released |
| * the lock. |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| if (RedoRecPtr < ptr) |
| RedoRecPtr = ptr; |
| |
| return RedoRecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Return information needed to decide whether a modified block needs a |
| * full-page image to be included in the WAL record. |
| * |
| * The returned values are cached copies from backend-private memory, and |
| * possibly out-of-date. XLogInsertRecord will re-check them against |
| * up-to-date values, while holding the WAL insert lock. |
| */ |
| void |
| GetFullPageWriteInfo(XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p) |
| { |
| *RedoRecPtr_p = RedoRecPtr; |
| *doPageWrites_p = doPageWrites; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * GetInsertRecPtr -- Returns the current insert position. |
| * |
| * NOTE: The value *actually* returned is the position of the last full |
| * xlog page. It lags behind the real insert position by at most 1 page. |
| * For that, we don't need to scan through WAL insertion locks, and an |
| * approximation is enough for the current usage of this function. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| GetInsertRecPtr(void) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| recptr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return recptr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * GetFlushRecPtr -- Returns the current flush position, ie, the last WAL |
| * position known to be fsync'd to disk. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| GetFlushRecPtr(void) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return LogwrtResult.Flush; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * GetLastImportantRecPtr -- Returns the LSN of the last important record |
| * inserted. All records not explicitly marked as unimportant are considered |
| * important. |
| * |
| * The LSN is determined by computing the maximum of |
| * WALInsertLocks[i].lastImportantAt. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| GetLastImportantRecPtr(void) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr res = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| int i; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr last_important; |
| |
| /* |
| * Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are |
| * possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only |
| * support exclusive mode, so we have to use that. |
| */ |
| LWLockAcquire(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| last_important = WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt; |
| LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock); |
| |
| if (res < last_important) |
| res = last_important; |
| } |
| |
| return res; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get the time and LSN of the last xlog segment switch |
| */ |
| pg_time_t |
| GetLastSegSwitchData(XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN) |
| { |
| pg_time_t result; |
| |
| /* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */ |
| LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_SHARED); |
| result = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime; |
| *lastSwitchLSN = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN; |
| LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock); |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend shutdown |
| */ |
| void |
| ShutdownXLOG(int code pg_attribute_unused() , Datum arg pg_attribute_unused() ) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not |
| * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner. |
| */ |
| Assert(AuxProcessResourceOwner != NULL); |
| Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL || |
| CurrentResourceOwner == AuxProcessResourceOwner); |
| CurrentResourceOwner = AuxProcessResourceOwner; |
| |
| /* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */ |
| ereport(IsPostmasterEnvironment ? LOG : NOTICE, |
| (errmsg("shutting down"))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Signal walsenders to move to stopping state. |
| */ |
| WalSndInitStopping(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state. This prevents commands |
| * from writing new WAL. |
| */ |
| WalSndWaitStopping(); |
| |
| if (RecoveryInProgress()) |
| CreateRestartPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE); |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the |
| * remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver |
| * process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint |
| * record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet). |
| */ |
| if (XLogArchivingActive() && XLogArchiveCommandSet()) |
| RequestXLogSwitch(false); |
| |
| CreateCheckPoint(CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Log start of a checkpoint. |
| */ |
| static void |
| LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint) |
| { |
| if (restartpoint) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */ |
| (errmsg("restartpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE) ? " immediate" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_ALL) ? " flush-all" : ""))); |
| else |
| ereport(LOG, |
| /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */ |
| (errmsg("checkpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE) ? " immediate" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_ALL) ? " flush-all" : ""))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Log end of a checkpoint. |
| */ |
| static void |
| LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint) |
| { |
| long write_msecs, |
| sync_msecs, |
| total_msecs, |
| longest_msecs, |
| average_msecs; |
| uint64 average_sync_time; |
| |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| |
| write_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t); |
| |
| sync_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t); |
| |
| /* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */ |
| BgWriterStats.m_checkpoint_write_time += write_msecs; |
| BgWriterStats.m_checkpoint_sync_time += sync_msecs; |
| |
| /* |
| * All of the published timing statistics are accounted for. Only |
| * continue if a log message is to be written. |
| */ |
| if (!log_checkpoints) |
| return; |
| |
| total_msecs = TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_end_t); |
| |
| /* |
| * Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds. |
| * Convert to milliseconds for consistent printing. |
| */ |
| longest_msecs = (long) ((CheckpointStats.ckpt_longest_sync + 999) / 1000); |
| |
| average_sync_time = 0; |
| if (CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels > 0) |
| average_sync_time = CheckpointStats.ckpt_agg_sync_time / |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels; |
| average_msecs = (long) ((average_sync_time + 999) / 1000); |
| |
| if (restartpoint) |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("restartpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%); " |
| "%d WAL file(s) added, %d removed, %d recycled; " |
| "write=%ld.%03d s, sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; " |
| "sync files=%d, longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; " |
| "distance=%d kB, estimate=%d kB", |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written, |
| (double) CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written * 100 / NBuffers, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled, |
| write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000), |
| sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000), |
| total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000), |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels, |
| longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000), |
| average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000), |
| (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0), |
| (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0)))); |
| else |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("checkpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%); " |
| "%d WAL file(s) added, %d removed, %d recycled; " |
| "write=%ld.%03d s, sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; " |
| "sync files=%d, longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; " |
| "distance=%d kB, estimate=%d kB", |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written, |
| (double) CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written * 100 / NBuffers, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled, |
| write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000), |
| sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000), |
| total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000), |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_rels, |
| longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000), |
| average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000), |
| (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0), |
| (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0)))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the estimate of distance between checkpoints. |
| * |
| * The estimate is used to calculate the number of WAL segments to keep |
| * preallocated, see XLOGfileslop(). |
| */ |
| static void |
| UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes) |
| { |
| /* |
| * To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a |
| * moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint |
| * cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy |
| * periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain |
| * moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle |
| * used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used |
| * more. |
| * |
| * When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to |
| * CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size, |
| * |
| * Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint. |
| * Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g. |
| * starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created |
| * automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are |
| * not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them |
| * in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and |
| * never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the |
| * preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever |
| * checkpoint_timeout is set to. |
| */ |
| PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes; |
| if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes) |
| CheckPointDistanceEstimate = nbytes; |
| else |
| CheckPointDistanceEstimate = |
| (0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the ps display for a process running a checkpoint. Note that |
| * this routine should not do any allocations so as it can be called |
| * from a critical section. |
| */ |
| static void |
| update_checkpoint_display(int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset) |
| { |
| /* |
| * The status is reported only for end-of-recovery and shutdown |
| * checkpoints or shutdown restartpoints. Updating the ps display is |
| * useful in those situations as it may not be possible to rely on |
| * pg_stat_activity to see the status of the checkpointer or the startup |
| * process. |
| */ |
| if ((flags & (CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY | CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)) == 0) |
| return; |
| |
| if (reset) |
| set_ps_display(""); |
| else |
| { |
| char activitymsg[128]; |
| |
| snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "performing %s%s%s", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? "end-of-recovery " : "", |
| (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? "shutdown " : "", |
| restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint"); |
| set_ps_display(activitymsg); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* |
| * Perform a checkpoint --- either during shutdown, or on-the-fly |
| * |
| * flags is a bitwise OR of the following: |
| * CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN: checkpoint is for database shutdown. |
| * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY: checkpoint is for end of WAL recovery. |
| * CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE: finish the checkpoint ASAP, |
| * ignoring checkpoint_completion_target parameter. |
| * CHECKPOINT_FORCE: force a checkpoint even if no XLOG activity has occurred |
| * since the last one (implied by CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN or |
| * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY). |
| * CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_ALL: also flush buffers of unlogged tables. |
| * |
| * Note: flags contains other bits, of interest here only for logging purposes. |
| * In particular note that this routine is synchronous and does not pay |
| * attention to CHECKPOINT_WAIT. |
| * |
| * If !shutdown then we are writing an online checkpoint. This is a very special |
| * kind of operation and WAL record because the checkpoint action occurs over |
| * a period of time yet logically occurs at just a single LSN. The logical |
| * position of the WAL record (redo ptr) is the same or earlier than the |
| * physical position. When we replay WAL we locate the checkpoint via its |
| * physical position then read the redo ptr and actually start replay at the |
| * earlier logical position. Note that we don't write *anything* to WAL at |
| * the logical position, so that location could be any other kind of WAL record. |
| * All of this mechanism allows us to continue working while we checkpoint. |
| * As a result, timing of actions is critical here and be careful to note that |
| * this function will likely take minutes to execute on a busy system. |
| */ |
| void |
| CreateCheckPoint(int flags) |
| { |
| bool shutdown; |
| CheckPoint checkPoint; |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| XLogSegNo _logSegNo; |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| char* dtxCheckPointInfo; |
| int dtxCheckPointInfoSize; |
| uint32 freespace; |
| XLogRecPtr PriorRedoPtr; |
| XLogRecPtr curInsert; |
| XLogRecPtr last_important_lsn; |
| VirtualTransactionId *vxids; |
| int nvxids; |
| |
| /* |
| * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just |
| * issued at a different time. |
| */ |
| if (flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)) |
| shutdown = true; |
| else |
| shutdown = false; |
| |
| #ifdef FAULT_INJECTOR |
| if (FaultInjector_InjectFaultIfSet( |
| "checkpoint", |
| DDLNotSpecified, |
| "" /* databaseName */, |
| "" /* tableName */) == FaultInjectorTypeSkip) |
| return; // skip checkpoint |
| #endif |
| |
| /* sanity check */ |
| if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0) |
| elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery"); |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize InitXLogInsert working areas before entering the critical |
| * section. Normally, this is done by the first call to |
| * RecoveryInProgress() or LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(), but when creating |
| * an end-of-recovery checkpoint, the LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed call is |
| * done below in a critical section, and InitXLogInsert cannot be called |
| * in a critical section. |
| */ |
| InitXLogInsert(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Prepare to accumulate statistics. |
| * |
| * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a |
| * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if |
| * log_checkpoints is currently off. |
| */ |
| MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats)); |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen outside the |
| * critical section and before we determine the REDO pointer. Note that |
| * smgr must not do anything that'd have to be undone if we decide no |
| * checkpoint is needed. |
| */ |
| SyncPreCheckpoint(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble. |
| */ |
| START_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| if (shutdown) |
| { |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNING; |
| ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| } |
| |
| /* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */ |
| MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint)); |
| checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| |
| /* |
| * For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo |
| * pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our |
| * starting snapshot of locks and transactions. |
| */ |
| if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive()) |
| checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId(); |
| else |
| checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = InvalidTransactionId; |
| |
| /* |
| * Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as |
| * GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks). |
| */ |
| last_important_lsn = GetLastImportantRecPtr(); |
| |
| /* |
| * We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state to |
| * determine the checkpoint REDO pointer. |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| curInsert = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(Insert->CurrBytePos); |
| |
| /* |
| * If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no |
| * WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it. The idea here is to |
| * avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle. |
| */ |
| if ((flags & (CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN | CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY | |
| CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0) |
| { |
| if (last_important_lsn == ControlFile->checkPoint) |
| { |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("checkpoint skipped because system is idle"))); |
| return; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to |
| * write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily |
| * enable XLogInsertAllowed. (This also ensures ThisTimeLineID is |
| * initialized, which we need here and in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.) |
| */ |
| if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) |
| LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(); |
| |
| checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID; |
| if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) |
| checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID; |
| else |
| checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID; |
| |
| checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites; |
| |
| /* |
| * Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record. |
| * |
| * NB: this is NOT necessarily where the checkpoint record itself will be, |
| * since other backends may insert more XLOG records while we're off doing |
| * the buffer flush work. Those XLOG records are logically after the |
| * checkpoint, even though physically before it. Got that? |
| */ |
| freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert); |
| if (freespace == 0) |
| { |
| if (XLogSegmentOffset(curInsert, wal_segment_size) == 0) |
| curInsert += SizeOfXLogLongPHD; |
| else |
| curInsert += SizeOfXLogShortPHD; |
| } |
| checkPoint.redo = curInsert; |
| |
| /* |
| * Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls; this |
| * must be done while holding all the insertion locks. |
| * |
| * Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be left |
| * pointing past where it really needs to point. This is okay; the only |
| * consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers that it |
| * didn't really need to. We can't postpone advancing RedoRecPtr because |
| * XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping buffers must assume that |
| * their buffer changes are not included in the checkpoint. |
| */ |
| RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo; |
| |
| /* |
| * Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to |
| * proceed while we are flushing disk buffers. |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| |
| /* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * If enabled, log checkpoint start. We postpone this until now so as not |
| * to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint. |
| */ |
| if (log_checkpoints) |
| LogCheckpointStart(flags, false); |
| |
| /* Update the process title */ |
| update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, false); |
| |
| TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_START(flags); |
| |
| /* |
| * Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record. |
| * |
| * We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters |
| * for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash |
| * during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid |
| * there. |
| */ |
| LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_SHARED); |
| checkPoint.nextXid = ShmemVariableCache->nextXid; |
| checkPoint.oldestXid = ShmemVariableCache->oldestXid; |
| checkPoint.oldestXidDB = ShmemVariableCache->oldestXidDB; |
| LWLockRelease(XidGenLock); |
| |
| /* |
| * GxidBumpLock and XLOG_NEXTGXID are used on content -1 only. So skipping |
| * locking GxidBumpLock on segments. |
| * |
| * We need to hold GxidBumpLock since XLOG_NEXTGXID is created with the |
| * lock held. nextGxid in online checkpoint is not used during replay but |
| * during crash recovery, it is used as the initial nextGxid so need to add |
| * the ShmemVariableCache->GxidCount variable. For the crash recovery case, |
| * if XLOG_NEXTGXID is created before checkpoint.redo, we get the nextGxid |
| * same as the XLOG_NEXTGXID value; else we rely on XLOG_NEXTGXID |
| * replay finally. See bumpGxid() for more details. |
| * |
| */ |
| if (IS_QUERY_DISPATCHER()) |
| LWLockAcquire(GxidBumpLock, LW_SHARED); |
| SpinLockAcquire(shmGxidGenLock); |
| checkPoint.nextGxid = ShmemVariableCache->nextGxid; |
| if (!shutdown) |
| checkPoint.nextGxid += ShmemVariableCache->GxidCount; |
| SpinLockRelease(shmGxidGenLock); |
| if (IS_QUERY_DISPATCHER()) |
| LWLockRelease(GxidBumpLock); |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(CommitTsLock, LW_SHARED); |
| checkPoint.oldestCommitTsXid = ShmemVariableCache->oldestCommitTsXid; |
| checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid = ShmemVariableCache->newestCommitTsXid; |
| LWLockRelease(CommitTsLock); |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_SHARED); |
| checkPoint.nextOid = ShmemVariableCache->nextOid; |
| if (!shutdown) |
| checkPoint.nextOid += ShmemVariableCache->oidCount; |
| LWLockRelease(OidGenLock); |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(RelfilenodeGenLock, LW_SHARED); |
| checkPoint.nextRelfilenode = ShmemVariableCache->nextRelfilenode; |
| if (!shutdown) |
| checkPoint.nextRelfilenode += ShmemVariableCache->relfilenodeCount; |
| LWLockRelease(RelfilenodeGenLock); |
| |
| MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(shutdown, |
| &checkPoint.nextMulti, |
| &checkPoint.nextMultiOffset, |
| &checkPoint.oldestMulti, |
| &checkPoint.oldestMultiDB); |
| |
| /* |
| * Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers |
| * and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk. |
| * |
| * This I/O could fail for various reasons. If so, we will fail to |
| * complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system |
| * panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it. |
| */ |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| SIMPLE_FAULT_INJECTOR("before_wait_VirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt"); |
| |
| /* |
| * In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one |
| * side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the |
| * checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently |
| * performing those groups of actions. |
| * |
| * One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions |
| * that are currently in commit critical sections. If an xact inserted |
| * its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash |
| * restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means |
| * that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact. So |
| * we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding. |
| * See notes in RecordTransactionCommit(). |
| * |
| * Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit |
| * fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need |
| * to wait for. But the delay should be short and it seems better to make |
| * checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than |
| * necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c |
| * does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps |
| * protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of |
| * minimizing lock contention.) |
| * |
| * A transaction that has not yet set delayChkpt when we look cannot be at |
| * risk, since he's not inserted his commit record yet; and one that's |
| * already cleared it is not at risk either, since he's done fixing clog |
| * and we will correctly flush the update below. So we cannot miss any |
| * xacts we need to wait for. |
| */ |
| vxids = GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(&nvxids); |
| if (nvxids > 0) |
| { |
| do |
| { |
| pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */ |
| } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids)); |
| } |
| pfree(vxids); |
| |
| /* |
| * When the crash happens, we need to handle the transactions that have |
| * already inserted 'commit' record and haven't inserted 'forget' record. |
| * |
| * If the 'commit' record is logically before the checkpoint REDO pointer, |
| * we save the transactions in checkpoint record, and these transactions |
| * will be load into shared memory and mark as 'crash committed' during |
| * redo checkpoint. |
| * If the 'commit' record is logically after the checkpoint REDO pointer, |
| * the transactions will be added to shared memory and mark as 'crash |
| * committed' during redo xact. |
| * All these transactions will be stored in the shutdown checkpoint record |
| * after recovery, and they will be finally recovered in recoverTM(). |
| * |
| * So if it's a shutdown checkpoint here, we should include all 'crash |
| * committed' transactions, and if it's a normal checkpoint should include |
| * all transactions whose 'commit' record is logically before checkpoint |
| * REDO pointer. |
| * |
| * We don't hold the WALInsertLock, so there's a time window that allows |
| * transactions insert 'commit' record and/or 'forget' record after |
| * checkpoint REDO pointer. That's fine, resend 'commit prepared' to already |
| * finished transactions is handled. |
| * |
| * Currently `MyTmGxact->includeInCkpt = true` and `XLogInsert(RM_XACT_ID, XLOG_XACT_DISTRIBUTED_COMMIT)` |
| * is already protected by delayChkpt, so these are an atomic operation |
| * from the outside perspective. getDtxCheckPointInfo() should be called |
| * after HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt() otherwise some distributed transactions |
| * with a state of DTX_STATE_INSERTED_COMMITTED may not be included in the |
| * checkpoint record. |
| */ |
| getDtxCheckPointInfo(&dtxCheckPointInfo, &dtxCheckPointInfoSize); |
| |
| CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags); |
| |
| vxids = GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkptEnd(&nvxids); |
| if (nvxids > 0) |
| { |
| do |
| { |
| pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */ |
| } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkptEnd(vxids, nvxids)); |
| } |
| pfree(vxids); |
| |
| /* |
| * Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This |
| * allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during |
| * archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled. |
| * |
| * If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash |
| * recovery we don't need to write running xact data. |
| */ |
| if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive()) |
| { |
| LogStandbySnapshot(); |
| |
| } |
| |
| SIMPLE_FAULT_INJECTOR("checkpoint_after_redo_calculated"); |
| |
| START_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG. |
| */ |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) (&checkPoint), sizeof(checkPoint)); |
| |
| /* Cloudberry checkpoints have extra info */ |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) dtxCheckPointInfo, dtxCheckPointInfoSize); |
| |
| recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, |
| shutdown ? XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN : |
| XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE); |
| |
| XLogFlush(recptr); |
| |
| pfree(dtxCheckPointInfo); |
| dtxCheckPointInfo = NULL; |
| |
| /* |
| * We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be |
| * overwritten at next startup. No-one should even try, this just allows |
| * sanity-checking. In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want |
| * to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited |
| * recovery. |
| */ |
| if (shutdown) |
| { |
| if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) |
| LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1; /* return to "check" state */ |
| else |
| LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr |
| * = end of actual checkpoint record. |
| */ |
| if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down"))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for |
| * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate() |
| */ |
| PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo; |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the control file. |
| */ |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| if (shutdown) |
| ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED; |
| ControlFile->checkPoint = ProcLastRecPtr; |
| ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint; |
| ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| /* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */ |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes |
| * unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always |
| * for debugging purposes. |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck); |
| ControlFile->unloggedLSN = XLogCtl->unloggedLSN; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->ulsn_lck); |
| |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| /* Update shared-memory copy of checkpoint XID/epoch */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we |
| * have trouble while fooling with old log segments. |
| */ |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| SIMPLE_FAULT_INJECTOR("checkpoint_control_file_updated"); |
| |
| /* |
| * Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files). |
| */ |
| SyncPostCheckpoint(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint |
| * exists. |
| */ |
| if (PriorRedoPtr != InvalidXLogRecPtr) |
| UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr); |
| |
| /* |
| * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to |
| * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full. |
| */ |
| XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo); |
| if (InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(_logSegNo)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment |
| * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr. |
| */ |
| XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo); |
| } |
| _logSegNo--; |
| RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, recptr); |
| |
| /* |
| * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log |
| * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.) |
| */ |
| if (!shutdown) |
| PreallocXlogFiles(recptr); |
| |
| /* |
| * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before |
| * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will |
| * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts |
| * in subtrans.c). During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because |
| * StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet. |
| */ |
| if (!RecoveryInProgress()) |
| TruncateSUBTRANS(GetLocalOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning()); |
| |
| /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */ |
| LogCheckpointEnd(false); |
| |
| /* Reset the process title */ |
| update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, true); |
| |
| TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_DONE(CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written, |
| NBuffers, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_added, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_removed, |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_segs_recycled); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Mark the end of recovery in WAL though without running a full checkpoint. |
| * We can expect that a restartpoint is likely to be in progress as we |
| * do this, though we are unwilling to wait for it to complete. |
| * |
| * CreateRestartPoint() allows for the case where recovery may end before |
| * the restartpoint completes so there is no concern of concurrent behaviour. |
| */ |
| static void |
| CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void) |
| { |
| xl_end_of_recovery xlrec; |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| |
| /* sanity check */ |
| if (!RecoveryInProgress()) |
| elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery"); |
| |
| xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| xlrec.ThisTimeLineID = ThisTimeLineID; |
| xlrec.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID; |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| |
| LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(); |
| |
| START_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery)); |
| recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY); |
| |
| XLogFlush(recptr); |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline |
| * changes to this point. |
| */ |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = recptr; |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = ThisTimeLineID; |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1; /* return to "check" state */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message. |
| * |
| * When on WAL replay we expect a continuation record at the start of a page |
| * that is not there, recovery ends and WAL writing resumes at that point. |
| * But it's wrong to resume writing new WAL back at the start of the record |
| * that was broken, because downstream consumers of that WAL (physical |
| * replicas) are not prepared to "rewind". So the first action after |
| * finishing replay of all valid WAL must be to write a record of this type |
| * at the point where the contrecord was missing; to support xlogreader |
| * detecting the special case, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD is also added |
| * to the page header where the record occurs. xlogreader has an ad-hoc |
| * mechanism to report metadata about the broken record, which is what we |
| * use here. |
| * |
| * At replay time, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD instructs xlogreader to |
| * skip the record it was reading, and pass back the LSN of the skipped |
| * record, so that its caller can verify (on "replay" of that record) that the |
| * XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD matches what was effectively overwritten. |
| */ |
| static XLogRecPtr |
| CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn) |
| { |
| xl_overwrite_contrecord xlrec; |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| |
| /* sanity check */ |
| if (!RecoveryInProgress()) |
| elog(ERROR, "can only be used at end of recovery"); |
| |
| xlrec.overwritten_lsn = aborted_lsn; |
| xlrec.overwrite_time = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| |
| START_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xl_overwrite_contrecord)); |
| |
| recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD); |
| |
| XLogFlush(recptr); |
| |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| return recptr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Flush all data in shared memory to disk, and fsync |
| * |
| * This is the common code shared between regular checkpoints and |
| * recovery restartpoints. |
| */ |
| static void |
| CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags) |
| { |
| CheckPointRelationMap(); |
| CheckPointReplicationSlots(); |
| CheckPointSnapBuild(); |
| CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap(); |
| CheckPointReplicationOrigin(); |
| |
| /* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */ |
| TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_START(flags); |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_write_t = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| CheckPointCLOG(); |
| CheckPointCommitTs(); |
| CheckPointSUBTRANS(); |
| CheckPointMultiXact(); |
| CheckPointPredicate(); |
| DistributedLog_CheckPoint(); |
| CheckPointBuffers(flags); |
| |
| /* Perform all queued up fsyncs */ |
| TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_SYNC_START(); |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_t = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| ProcessSyncRequests(); |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_sync_end_t = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_DONE(); |
| |
| /* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */ |
| CheckPointTwoPhase(checkPointRedo); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Save a checkpoint for recovery restart if appropriate |
| * |
| * This function is called each time a checkpoint record is read from XLOG. |
| * It must determine whether the checkpoint represents a safe restartpoint or |
| * not. If so, the checkpoint record is stashed in shared memory so that |
| * CreateRestartPoint can consult it. (Note that the latter function is |
| * executed by the checkpointer, while this one will be executed by the |
| * startup process.) |
| */ |
| static void |
| RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any |
| * references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the |
| * restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the |
| * cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped |
| * later. |
| */ |
| if (XLogHaveInvalidPages()) |
| { |
| elog(trace_recovery(DEBUG2), |
| "could not record restart point at %X/%X because there " |
| "are unresolved references to invalid pages", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint->redo)); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can |
| * work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint. |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr = ReadRecPtr; |
| XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr = EndRecPtr; |
| XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Establish a restartpoint if possible. |
| * |
| * This is similar to CreateCheckPoint, but is used during WAL recovery |
| * to establish a point from which recovery can roll forward without |
| * replaying the entire recovery log. |
| * |
| * Returns true if a new restartpoint was established. We can only establish |
| * a restartpoint if we have replayed a safe checkpoint record since last |
| * restartpoint. |
| */ |
| bool |
| CreateRestartPoint(int flags) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr; |
| XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr; |
| CheckPoint lastCheckPoint; |
| XLogRecPtr PriorRedoPtr; |
| XLogRecPtr receivePtr; |
| XLogRecPtr replayPtr; |
| TimeLineID replayTLI; |
| XLogRecPtr endptr; |
| XLogSegNo _logSegNo; |
| TimestampTz xtime; |
| |
| /* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr; |
| lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr; |
| lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery |
| * mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway. |
| */ |
| if (!RecoveryInProgress()) |
| { |
| ereport(DEBUG2, |
| (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended"))); |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last |
| * restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update |
| * minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart |
| * point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly |
| * necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if |
| * the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time |
| * before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of |
| * immediate shutdown, though. |
| * |
| * We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a |
| * restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a |
| * side-effect. |
| */ |
| if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) || |
| lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo) |
| { |
| ereport(DEBUG2, |
| (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)))); |
| |
| UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(InvalidXLogRecPtr, true); |
| if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) |
| { |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY; |
| ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| } |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate |
| * the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a |
| * restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments. |
| * |
| * Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although |
| * during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are |
| * happening. |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo; |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| |
| /* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * Prepare to accumulate statistics. |
| * |
| * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a |
| * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if |
| * log_checkpoints is currently off. |
| */ |
| MemSet(&CheckpointStats, 0, sizeof(CheckpointStats)); |
| CheckpointStats.ckpt_start_t = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| |
| if (log_checkpoints) |
| LogCheckpointStart(flags, true); |
| |
| /* Update the process title */ |
| update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, false); |
| |
| CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags); |
| |
| SIMPLE_FAULT_INJECTOR("restartpoint_guts"); |
| |
| /* |
| * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for |
| * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate() |
| */ |
| PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo; |
| |
| /* |
| * Update pg_control, using current time. Check that it still shows an |
| * older checkpoint, else do nothing; this is a quick hack to make sure |
| * nothing really bad happens if somehow we get here after the |
| * end-of-recovery checkpoint. |
| */ |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| if (ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Update the checkpoint information. We do this even if the cluster |
| * does not show DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY to match with the set of WAL |
| * segments recycled below. |
| */ |
| ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr; |
| ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint; |
| ControlFile->time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| |
| /* |
| * Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record and update it |
| * if the control file still shows DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY. Normally, |
| * this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers, |
| * but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied. We do |
| * this because a non-exclusive base backup uses minRecoveryPoint to |
| * determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and the |
| * file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be included, |
| * at a minimum. Note that for an ordinary restart of recovery there's |
| * no value in having the minimum recovery point any earlier than this |
| * anyway, because redo will begin just after the checkpoint record. |
| * this because a non-exclusive base backup uses minRecoveryPoint to |
| * determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and the |
| * file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be included, |
| * at a minimum. Note that for an ordinary restart of recovery there's |
| * no value in having the minimum recovery point any earlier than this |
| * anyway, because redo will begin just after the checkpoint record. |
| */ |
| if (ControlFile->state == DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY) |
| { |
| if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr) |
| { |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr; |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = lastCheckPoint.ThisTimeLineID; |
| |
| /* update local copy */ |
| minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint; |
| minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI; |
| } |
| if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) |
| ControlFile->state = DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY; |
| } |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| } |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the |
| * prior checkpoint exists. |
| */ |
| if (PriorRedoPtr != InvalidXLogRecPtr) |
| UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(RedoRecPtr - PriorRedoPtr); |
| |
| /* |
| * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to |
| * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full. |
| */ |
| XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* |
| * Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received, |
| * whichever is later. |
| */ |
| receivePtr = GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(NULL, NULL); |
| replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI); |
| endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr; |
| KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo); |
| if (InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(_logSegNo)) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment |
| * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr. |
| */ |
| XLByteToSeg(RedoRecPtr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo); |
| } |
| _logSegNo--; |
| |
| /* |
| * Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted |
| * since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen |
| * at end of recovery (RecoveryInProgress() sets ThisTimeLineID in that |
| * case). If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're currently |
| * replaying. |
| * |
| * There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the |
| * current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after |
| * this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used, |
| * and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live |
| * with that. |
| */ |
| if (RecoveryInProgress()) |
| ThisTimeLineID = replayTLI; |
| |
| RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr); |
| |
| /* |
| * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log |
| * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.) |
| */ |
| PreallocXlogFiles(endptr); |
| |
| /* |
| * ThisTimeLineID is normally not set when we're still in recovery. |
| * However, recycling/preallocating segments above needed ThisTimeLineID |
| * to determine which timeline to install the segments on. Reset it now, |
| * to restore the normal state of affairs for debugging purposes. |
| */ |
| if (RecoveryInProgress()) |
| ThisTimeLineID = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before |
| * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will |
| * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts |
| * in subtrans.c). When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do |
| * this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet. |
| */ |
| if (EnableHotStandby) |
| TruncateSUBTRANS(GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning()); |
| |
| /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */ |
| LogCheckpointEnd(true); |
| |
| /* Reset the process title */ |
| update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, true); |
| |
| xtime = GetLatestXTime(); |
| ereport((log_checkpoints ? LOG : DEBUG2), |
| (errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)), |
| xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.", |
| timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any. |
| */ |
| if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0) |
| ExecuteRecoveryCommand(archiveCleanupCommand, |
| "archive_cleanup_command", |
| false); |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Report availability of WAL for the given target LSN |
| * (typically a slot's restart_lsn) |
| * |
| * Returns one of the following enum values: |
| * |
| * * WALAVAIL_RESERVED means targetLSN is available and it is in the range of |
| * max_wal_size. |
| * |
| * * WALAVAIL_EXTENDED means it is still available by preserving extra |
| * segments beyond max_wal_size. If max_slot_wal_keep_size is smaller |
| * than max_wal_size, this state is not returned. |
| * |
| * * WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED means it is being lost and the next checkpoint will |
| * remove reserved segments. The walsender using this slot may return to the |
| * above. |
| * |
| * * WALAVAIL_REMOVED means it has been removed. A replication stream on |
| * a slot with this LSN cannot continue after a restart. |
| * |
| * * WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN means the slot hasn't been set to reserve WAL. |
| */ |
| WALAvailability |
| GetWALAvailability(XLogRecPtr targetLSN) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr currpos; /* current write LSN */ |
| XLogSegNo currSeg; /* segid of currpos */ |
| XLogSegNo targetSeg; /* segid of targetLSN */ |
| XLogSegNo oldestSeg; /* actual oldest segid */ |
| XLogSegNo oldestSegMaxWalSize; /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */ |
| XLogSegNo oldestSlotSeg; /* oldest segid kept by slot */ |
| uint64 keepSegs; |
| |
| /* |
| * slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active |
| */ |
| if (XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(targetLSN)) |
| return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN; |
| |
| /* |
| * Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots, |
| * considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size. Initialize |
| * oldestSlotSeg to the current segment. |
| */ |
| currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr(); |
| |
| /* calculate oldest segment currently needed by slots */ |
| XLByteToSeg(currpos, oldestSlotSeg, wal_segment_size); |
| KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg); |
| |
| /* |
| * Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes |
| * the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being |
| * wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm. |
| */ |
| oldestSeg = XLogGetLastRemovedSegno() + 1; |
| |
| /* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */ |
| XLByteToSeg(currpos, currSeg, wal_segment_size); |
| keepSegs = ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) + 1; |
| |
| if (currSeg > keepSegs) |
| oldestSegMaxWalSize = currSeg - keepSegs; |
| else |
| oldestSegMaxWalSize = 1; |
| |
| /* the segment we care about */ |
| XLByteToSeg(targetLSN, targetSeg, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* |
| * No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the |
| * targetSeg is known to be lost. |
| */ |
| if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg) |
| { |
| /* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */ |
| if (targetSeg >= oldestSegMaxWalSize) |
| return WALAVAIL_RESERVED; |
| |
| /* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */ |
| return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED; |
| } |
| |
| /* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */ |
| if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg) |
| return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED; |
| |
| /* Definitely lost */ |
| return WALAVAIL_REMOVED; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* |
| * Retreat *logSegNo to the last segment that we need to retain because of |
| * either wal_keep_size or replication slots. |
| * |
| * This is calculated by subtracting wal_keep_size from the given xlog |
| * location, recptr and by making sure that that result is below the |
| * requirement of replication slots. For the latter criterion we do consider |
| * the effects of max_slot_wal_keep_size: reserve at most that much space back |
| * from recptr. |
| * |
| * Note about replication slots: if this function calculates a value |
| * that's further ahead than what slots need reserved, then affected |
| * slots need to be invalidated and this function invoked again. |
| * XXX it might be a good idea to rewrite this function so that |
| * invalidation is optionally done here, instead. |
| */ |
| static void |
| KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo) |
| { |
| XLogSegNo currSegNo; |
| XLogSegNo segno; |
| XLogRecPtr keep; |
| |
| XLByteToSeg(recptr, currSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| segno = currSegNo; |
| |
| /* |
| * Calculate how many segments are kept by slots first, adjusting for |
| * max_slot_wal_keep_size. |
| * |
| * Greenplum: coordinator needs a different way to determine the keep |
| * point as replication slot is not created there. |
| */ |
| keep = IS_QUERY_DISPATCHER() ? |
| WalSndCtlGetXLogCleanUpTo() : |
| XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(); |
| |
| #ifdef FAULT_INJECTOR |
| /* |
| * Ignore the replication slot's LSN and let the WAL still needed by the |
| * replication slot to be removed. This is used to test if WAL sender can |
| * recognize that an incremental recovery has failed when the WAL |
| * requested by a mirror no longer exists. |
| */ |
| if (SIMPLE_FAULT_INJECTOR("keep_log_seg") == FaultInjectorTypeSkip) |
| keep = GetXLogWriteRecPtr(); |
| #endif |
| |
| if (keep != InvalidXLogRecPtr) |
| { |
| XLByteToSeg(keep, segno, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* Cap by max_slot_wal_keep_size ... */ |
| if (max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb >= 0) |
| { |
| uint64 slot_keep_segs; |
| |
| slot_keep_segs = |
| ConvertToXSegs(max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs) |
| segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */ |
| if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0) |
| { |
| uint64 keep_segs; |
| |
| keep_segs = ConvertToXSegs(wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size); |
| if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs) |
| { |
| /* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */ |
| if (currSegNo <= keep_segs) |
| segno = 1; |
| else |
| segno = currSegNo - keep_segs; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */ |
| if (segno < *logSegNo) |
| *logSegNo = segno; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Write a NEXTOID log record |
| */ |
| void |
| XLogPutNextOid(Oid nextOid) |
| { |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) (&nextOid), sizeof(Oid)); |
| (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_NEXTOID); |
| |
| /* |
| * We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the |
| * just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or |
| * update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID |
| * record. Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those |
| * records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record |
| * does. |
| * |
| * Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the |
| * database. When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we |
| * are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem |
| * change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does. The impact |
| * of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we |
| * might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts |
| * with the leftover file or directory. But since for safety's sake we |
| * always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real |
| * problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006. |
| */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Write a NEXTRELFILENODE log record similar to XLogPutNextOid |
| */ |
| void |
| XLogPutNextRelfilenode(Oid nextRelfilenode) |
| { |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) (&nextRelfilenode), sizeof(Oid)); |
| (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_NEXTRELFILENODE); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| XLogPutNextGxid(DistributedTransactionId nextGxid) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) (&nextGxid), sizeof(nextGxid)); |
| recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_NEXTGXID); |
| |
| XLogFlush(recptr); |
| /* |
| * For one phase, there isn't transaction on the coordinator, so without |
| * the below code, this kind of xlog might not be streamed to the standby |
| * in time so the standby might fail to track the NextGxid information |
| * after promote. |
| */ |
| /* |
| * SyncRepWaitForLSN assumes that the caller has hold interrupts. It's |
| * not obvious because calling HOLD_INTERRUPTS() doesn't appears near |
| * SyncRepWaitForLSN(). Enabling interrupts may cause some issues. |
| * |
| * See more details: |
| * https://github.com/postgres/postgres/commit/e174f699c476a4cc01875211a5f43e57c3190a37 |
| * https://www.postgresql.org/message-id/flat/a0806273-8bbb-43b3-bbe1-c45a58f6ae21.lingce.ldm%40alibaba-inc.com |
| */ |
| HOLD_INTERRUPTS(); |
| SyncRepWaitForLSN(recptr, true); |
| RESUME_INTERRUPTS(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Write an XLOG SWITCH record. |
| * |
| * Here we just blindly issue an XLogInsert request for the record. |
| * All the magic happens inside XLogInsert. |
| * |
| * The return value is either the end+1 address of the switch record, |
| * or the end+1 address of the prior segment if we did not need to |
| * write a switch record because we are already at segment start. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr RecPtr; |
| |
| /* XLOG SWITCH has no data */ |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| |
| if (mark_unimportant) |
| XLogSetRecordFlags(XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT); |
| RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_SWITCH); |
| |
| return RecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Write a RESTORE POINT record |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| XLogRestorePoint(const char *rpName) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr RecPtr; |
| xl_restore_point xlrec; |
| |
| xlrec.rp_time = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN); |
| |
| /* LogHotStandby for the restore here */ |
| LogStandbySnapshot(); |
| |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xl_restore_point)); |
| |
| RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_RESTORE_POINT); |
| |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%X", |
| rpName, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(RecPtr)))); |
| |
| return RecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check if any of the GUC parameters that are critical for hot standby |
| * have changed, and update the value in pg_control file if necessary. |
| */ |
| static void |
| XLogReportParameters(void) |
| { |
| if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level || |
| wal_log_hints != ControlFile->wal_log_hints || |
| MaxConnections != ControlFile->MaxConnections || |
| max_worker_processes != ControlFile->max_worker_processes || |
| max_wal_senders != ControlFile->max_wal_senders || |
| max_prepared_xacts != ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts || |
| max_locks_per_xact != ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact || |
| track_commit_timestamp != ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp) |
| { |
| /* |
| * The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged |
| * if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery |
| * with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the |
| * values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better |
| * to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion. |
| */ |
| if (wal_level != ControlFile->wal_level || XLogIsNeeded()) |
| { |
| xl_parameter_change xlrec; |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| |
| xlrec.MaxConnections = MaxConnections; |
| xlrec.max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes; |
| xlrec.max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders; |
| xlrec.max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts; |
| xlrec.max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact; |
| xlrec.wal_level = wal_level; |
| xlrec.wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints; |
| xlrec.track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp; |
| |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) &xlrec, sizeof(xlrec)); |
| |
| recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE); |
| XLogFlush(recptr); |
| } |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| |
| ControlFile->MaxConnections = MaxConnections; |
| ControlFile->max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes; |
| ControlFile->max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders; |
| ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts; |
| ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact; |
| ControlFile->wal_level = wal_level; |
| ControlFile->wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints; |
| ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp; |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Update full_page_writes in shared memory, and write an |
| * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record if necessary. |
| * |
| * Note: this function assumes there is no other process running |
| * concurrently that could update it. |
| */ |
| void |
| UpdateFullPageWrites(void) |
| { |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| bool recoveryInProgress; |
| |
| /* |
| * Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed. |
| * |
| * It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock, |
| * because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which |
| * can update it. |
| */ |
| if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites) |
| return; |
| |
| /* |
| * Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert |
| * initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an |
| * assertion failure. |
| */ |
| recoveryInProgress = RecoveryInProgress(); |
| |
| START_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| |
| /* |
| * It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly |
| * required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes |
| * to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're |
| * setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global |
| * flag. |
| */ |
| if (fullPageWrites) |
| { |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| Insert->fullPageWrites = true; |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of |
| * full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required. |
| */ |
| if (XLogStandbyInfoActive() && !recoveryInProgress) |
| { |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) (&fullPageWrites), sizeof(bool)); |
| |
| XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_FPW_CHANGE); |
| } |
| |
| if (!fullPageWrites) |
| { |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| Insert->fullPageWrites = false; |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| } |
| END_CRIT_SECTION(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check that it's OK to switch to new timeline during recovery. |
| * |
| * 'lsn' is the address of the shutdown checkpoint record we're about to |
| * replay. (Currently, timeline can only change at a shutdown checkpoint). |
| */ |
| static void |
| checkTimeLineSwitch(XLogRecPtr lsn, TimeLineID newTLI, TimeLineID prevTLI) |
| { |
| /* Check that the record agrees on what the current (old) timeline is */ |
| if (prevTLI != ThisTimeLineID) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("unexpected previous timeline ID %u (current timeline ID %u) in checkpoint record", |
| prevTLI, ThisTimeLineID))); |
| |
| /* |
| * The new timeline better be in the list of timelines we expect to see, |
| * according to the timeline history. It should also not decrease. |
| */ |
| if (newTLI < ThisTimeLineID || !tliInHistory(newTLI, expectedTLEs)) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (after %u) in checkpoint record", |
| newTLI, ThisTimeLineID))); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we have not yet reached min recovery point, and we're about to |
| * switch to a timeline greater than the timeline of the min recovery |
| * point: trouble. After switching to the new timeline, we could not |
| * possibly visit the min recovery point on the correct timeline anymore. |
| * This can happen if there is a newer timeline in the archive that |
| * branched before the timeline the min recovery point is on, and you |
| * attempt to do PITR to the new timeline. |
| */ |
| if (!XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(minRecoveryPoint) && |
| lsn < minRecoveryPoint && |
| newTLI > minRecoveryPointTLI) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u in checkpoint record, before reaching minimum recovery point %X/%X on timeline %u", |
| newTLI, |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(minRecoveryPoint), |
| minRecoveryPointTLI))); |
| |
| /* Looks good */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * XLOG resource manager's routines |
| * |
| * Definitions of info values are in include/catalog/pg_control.h, though |
| * not all record types are related to control file updates. |
| */ |
| void |
| xlog_redo(XLogReaderState *record) |
| { |
| uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK; |
| XLogRecPtr lsn = record->EndRecPtr; |
| |
| /* in XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI records */ |
| Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT || |
| !XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record)); |
| |
| if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID) |
| { |
| Oid nextOid; |
| |
| /* |
| * We used to try to take the maximum of ShmemVariableCache->nextOid |
| * and the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps |
| * around. Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay |
| * anyway, better to just believe the record exactly. We still take |
| * OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case. |
| */ |
| memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid)); |
| LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextOid = nextOid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->oidCount = 0; |
| LWLockRelease(OidGenLock); |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_NEXTGXID) |
| { |
| DistributedTransactionId nextGxid; |
| |
| nextGxid = *((DistributedTransactionId *)XLogRecGetData(record)); |
| SpinLockAcquire(shmGxidGenLock); |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextGxid = nextGxid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->GxidCount = 0; |
| SpinLockRelease(shmGxidGenLock); |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_NEXTRELFILENODE) |
| { |
| Oid nextRelfilenode; |
| |
| memcpy(&nextRelfilenode, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid)); |
| LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextRelfilenode = nextRelfilenode; |
| ShmemVariableCache->relfilenodeCount = 0; |
| LWLockRelease(OidGenLock); |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN) |
| { |
| CheckPoint checkPoint; |
| |
| memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint)); |
| /* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */ |
| LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| LWLockRelease(XidGenLock); |
| SpinLockAcquire(shmGxidGenLock); |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextGxid = checkPoint.nextGxid; |
| SpinLockRelease(shmGxidGenLock); |
| LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid; |
| ShmemVariableCache->oidCount = 0; |
| LWLockRelease(OidGenLock); |
| LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextRelfilenode = checkPoint.nextRelfilenode; |
| ShmemVariableCache->relfilenodeCount = 0; |
| LWLockRelease(OidGenLock); |
| MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, |
| checkPoint.nextMultiOffset); |
| |
| MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti, |
| checkPoint.oldestMultiDB); |
| |
| /* |
| * No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we |
| * redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization. |
| */ |
| SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup |
| * record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will |
| * never arrive. |
| */ |
| if (ArchiveRecoveryRequested && |
| !XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupStartPoint) && |
| XLogRecPtrIsInvalid(ControlFile->backupEndPoint)) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue"))); |
| |
| /* |
| * If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running |
| * on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts |
| * record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state |
| * for prepared transactions. |
| */ |
| if (standbyState >= STANDBY_INITIALIZED) |
| { |
| TransactionId *xids; |
| int nxids; |
| TransactionId oldestActiveXID; |
| TransactionId latestCompletedXid; |
| RunningTransactionsData running; |
| |
| oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids); |
| |
| /* |
| * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut |
| * down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're |
| * never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed |
| * with their parent prepared transactions. |
| */ |
| running.xcnt = nxids; |
| running.subxcnt = 0; |
| running.subxid_overflow = false; |
| running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid); |
| running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID; |
| latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid); |
| TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid); |
| Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid)); |
| running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid; |
| running.xids = xids; |
| |
| ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(&running); |
| |
| StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions(); |
| } |
| |
| /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */ |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| /* Update shared-memory copy of checkpoint XID/epoch */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this |
| * record. |
| */ |
| if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != ThisTimeLineID) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in checkpoint record", |
| checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, ThisTimeLineID))); |
| |
| RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint); |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE) |
| { |
| CheckPoint checkPoint; |
| |
| memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint)); |
| /* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */ |
| LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| if (FullTransactionIdPrecedes(ShmemVariableCache->nextXid, |
| checkPoint.nextXid)) |
| ShmemVariableCache->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| LWLockRelease(XidGenLock); |
| |
| /* |
| * We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring |
| * to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records. The nextOid |
| * counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale |
| * compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records. We could try to take the |
| * maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since |
| * there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID |
| * counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do. In any case, |
| * users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of |
| * duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe. |
| */ |
| |
| /* |
| * We ignore the nextGxid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint. See code |
| * that creates checkpoint (CreateCheckPoint()) for details. |
| */ |
| |
| /* Handle multixact */ |
| MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, |
| checkPoint.nextMultiOffset); |
| |
| /* |
| * NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL |
| * generated by an older primary. |
| */ |
| MultiXactAdvanceOldest(checkPoint.oldestMulti, |
| checkPoint.oldestMultiDB); |
| if (TransactionIdPrecedes(ShmemVariableCache->oldestXid, |
| checkPoint.oldestXid)) |
| SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, |
| checkPoint.oldestXidDB); |
| /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */ |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ControlFile->checkPointCopy.nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| /* Update shared-memory copy of checkpoint XID/epoch */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->ckptFullXid = checkPoint.nextXid; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */ |
| if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != ThisTimeLineID) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in checkpoint record", |
| checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, ThisTimeLineID))); |
| |
| RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint); |
| |
| SIMPLE_FAULT_INJECTOR("after_xlog_redo_checkpoint_online"); |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD) |
| { |
| xl_overwrite_contrecord xlrec; |
| |
| memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_overwrite_contrecord)); |
| VerifyOverwriteContrecord(&xlrec, record); |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY) |
| { |
| xl_end_of_recovery xlrec; |
| |
| memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery)); |
| |
| /* |
| * For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint, |
| * but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't |
| * outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance. |
| */ |
| |
| /* |
| * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this |
| * record. |
| */ |
| if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != ThisTimeLineID) |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in checkpoint record", |
| xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, ThisTimeLineID))); |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_NOOP) |
| { |
| SIMPLE_FAULT_INJECTOR("after_xlog_redo_noop"); |
| /* nothing to do here */ |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH) |
| { |
| /* nothing to do here */ |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT) |
| { |
| /* nothing to do here */ |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Full-page image (FPI) records contain nothing else but a backup |
| * block (or multiple backup blocks). Every block reference must |
| * include a full-page image - otherwise there would be no point in |
| * this record. |
| * |
| * No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a |
| * resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a |
| * separate WAL record type and redo routine. |
| * |
| * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be |
| * WAL- logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated |
| * when checksums are enabled. There is no difference in handling |
| * XLOG_FPI and XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records, they use a different info |
| * code just to distinguish them for statistics purposes. |
| */ |
| for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= record->max_block_id; block_id++) |
| { |
| Buffer buffer; |
| XLogRedoAction result; |
| |
| result = XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer); |
| if (result == BLK_DONE && !IsUnderPostmaster) |
| { |
| /* |
| * In the special WAL process, blocks that are being ignored |
| * return BLK_DONE. Accept that. |
| */ |
| } |
| else if (result != BLK_RESTORED) |
| elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block"); |
| |
| UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_ENCRYPTION_LSN) |
| { |
| /* nothing to do here */ |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr startpoint; |
| |
| memcpy(&startpoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(startpoint)); |
| |
| if (ControlFile->backupStartPoint == startpoint) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We have reached the end of base backup, the point where |
| * pg_stop_backup() was done. The data on disk is now consistent. |
| * Reset backupStartPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to make |
| * sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if |
| * recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this. |
| */ |
| elog(DEBUG1, "end of backup reached"); |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| |
| if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lsn) |
| { |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lsn; |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = ThisTimeLineID; |
| } |
| ControlFile->backupStartPoint = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| ControlFile->backupEndRequired = false; |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE) |
| { |
| xl_parameter_change xlrec; |
| |
| /* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */ |
| memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change)); |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE); |
| ControlFile->MaxConnections = xlrec.MaxConnections; |
| ControlFile->max_worker_processes = xlrec.max_worker_processes; |
| ControlFile->max_wal_senders = xlrec.max_wal_senders; |
| ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = xlrec.max_prepared_xacts; |
| ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = xlrec.max_locks_per_xact; |
| ControlFile->wal_level = xlrec.wal_level; |
| ControlFile->wal_log_hints = xlrec.wal_log_hints; |
| |
| /* |
| * Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we |
| * recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again. |
| * This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure |
| * you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The |
| * local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is |
| * happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed. |
| */ |
| if (InArchiveRecovery) |
| { |
| minRecoveryPoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint; |
| minRecoveryPointTLI = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI; |
| } |
| if (minRecoveryPoint != InvalidXLogRecPtr && minRecoveryPoint < lsn) |
| { |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lsn; |
| ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = ThisTimeLineID; |
| } |
| |
| CommitTsParameterChange(xlrec.track_commit_timestamp, |
| ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp); |
| ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = xlrec.track_commit_timestamp; |
| |
| UpdateControlFile(); |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| /* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */ |
| CheckRequiredParameterValues(); |
| } |
| else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE) |
| { |
| bool fpw; |
| |
| memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that |
| * do_pg_start_backup() and do_pg_stop_backup() can check whether |
| * full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup. |
| */ |
| if (!fpw) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| if (XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr < ReadRecPtr) |
| XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr = ReadRecPtr; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| |
| /* Keep track of full_page_writes */ |
| lastFullPageWrites = fpw; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Verify the payload of a XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD record. |
| */ |
| static void |
| VerifyOverwriteContrecord(xl_overwrite_contrecord *xlrec, XLogReaderState *state) |
| { |
| if (xlrec->overwritten_lsn != state->overwrittenRecPtr) |
| elog(FATAL, "mismatching overwritten LSN %X/%X -> %X/%X", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(xlrec->overwritten_lsn), |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(state->overwrittenRecPtr)); |
| |
| /* We have safely skipped the aborted record */ |
| abortedRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| missingContrecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| |
| /* We have safely skipped the aborted record */ |
| abortedRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| missingContrecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("successfully skipped missing contrecord at %X/%X, overwritten at %s", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(xlrec->overwritten_lsn), |
| timestamptz_to_str(xlrec->overwrite_time)))); |
| |
| /* Verifying the record should only happen once */ |
| state->overwrittenRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef WAL_DEBUG |
| |
| static void |
| xlog_outrec(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record) |
| { |
| appendStringInfo(buf, "prev %X/%X; xid %u", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(XLogRecGetPrev(record)), |
| XLogRecGetXid(record)); |
| |
| appendStringInfo(buf, "; len %u", |
| XLogRecGetDataLen(record)); |
| |
| xlog_block_info(buf, record); |
| } |
| #endif /* WAL_DEBUG */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns a string giving information about all the blocks in an |
| * XLogRecord. |
| */ |
| static void |
| xlog_block_info(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record) |
| { |
| int block_id; |
| |
| /* decode block references */ |
| for (block_id = 0; block_id <= record->max_block_id; block_id++) |
| { |
| RelFileNode rnode; |
| ForkNumber forknum; |
| BlockNumber blk; |
| |
| if (!XLogRecHasBlockRef(record, block_id)) |
| continue; |
| |
| XLogRecGetBlockTag(record, block_id, &rnode, &forknum, &blk); |
| if (forknum != MAIN_FORKNUM) |
| appendStringInfo(buf, "; blkref #%u: rel %u/%u/%u, fork %u, blk %u", |
| block_id, |
| rnode.spcNode, rnode.dbNode, rnode.relNode, |
| forknum, |
| blk); |
| else |
| appendStringInfo(buf, "; blkref #%u: rel %u/%u/%u, blk %u", |
| block_id, |
| rnode.spcNode, rnode.dbNode, rnode.relNode, |
| blk); |
| if (XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id)) |
| appendStringInfoString(buf, " FPW"); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns a string describing an XLogRecord, consisting of its identity |
| * optionally followed by a colon, a space, and a further description. |
| */ |
| static void |
| xlog_outdesc(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record) |
| { |
| RmgrId rmid = XLogRecGetRmid(record); |
| uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record); |
| const char *id; |
| |
| appendStringInfoString(buf, RmgrTable[rmid].rm_name); |
| appendStringInfoChar(buf, '/'); |
| |
| id = RmgrTable[rmid].rm_identify(info); |
| if (id == NULL) |
| appendStringInfo(buf, "UNKNOWN (%X): ", info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK); |
| else |
| appendStringInfo(buf, "%s: ", id); |
| |
| RmgrTable[rmid].rm_desc(buf, record); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* |
| * Return the (possible) sync flag used for opening a file, depending on the |
| * value of the GUC wal_sync_method. |
| */ |
| static int |
| get_sync_bit(int method) |
| { |
| int o_direct_flag = 0; |
| |
| /* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */ |
| if (!enableFsync) |
| return 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Optimize writes by bypassing kernel cache with O_DIRECT when using |
| * O_SYNC/O_FSYNC and O_DSYNC. But only if archiving and streaming are |
| * disabled, otherwise the archive command or walsender process will read |
| * the WAL soon after writing it, which is guaranteed to cause a physical |
| * read if we bypassed the kernel cache. We also skip the |
| * posix_fadvise(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED) call in XLogFileClose() for the same |
| * reason. |
| * |
| * Never use O_DIRECT in walreceiver process for similar reasons; the WAL |
| * written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon |
| * after it's written. Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which |
| * don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too. |
| */ |
| if (!XLogIsNeeded() && !AmWalReceiverProcess()) |
| o_direct_flag = PG_O_DIRECT; |
| |
| switch (method) |
| { |
| /* |
| * enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are |
| * not supported on the current platform. But if not, they are |
| * not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never |
| * be seen here. |
| */ |
| case SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC: |
| case SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH: |
| case SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC: |
| return 0; |
| #ifdef OPEN_SYNC_FLAG |
| case SYNC_METHOD_OPEN: |
| return OPEN_SYNC_FLAG | o_direct_flag; |
| #endif |
| #ifdef OPEN_DATASYNC_FLAG |
| case SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC: |
| return OPEN_DATASYNC_FLAG | o_direct_flag; |
| #endif |
| default: |
| /* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */ |
| elog(ERROR, "unrecognized wal_sync_method: %d", method); |
| return 0; /* silence warning */ |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * GUC support |
| */ |
| void |
| assign_xlog_sync_method(int new_sync_method, void *extra) |
| { |
| if (sync_method != new_sync_method) |
| { |
| /* |
| * To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the |
| * currently open log segment (if any). Also, if the open flag is |
| * changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag |
| * bit) at next use. |
| */ |
| if (openLogFile >= 0) |
| { |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD_ASSIGN); |
| if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0) |
| { |
| char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| int save_errno; |
| |
| save_errno = errno; |
| XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, openLogSegNo, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| errno = save_errno; |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname))); |
| } |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| if (get_sync_bit(sync_method) != get_sync_bit(new_sync_method)) |
| XLogFileClose(); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* |
| * Issue appropriate kind of fsync (if any) for an XLOG output file. |
| * |
| * 'fd' is a file descriptor for the XLOG file to be fsync'd. |
| * 'segno' is for error reporting purposes. |
| */ |
| void |
| issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno) |
| { |
| char *msg = NULL; |
| instr_time start; |
| |
| /* |
| * Quick exit if fsync is disabled or write() has already synced the WAL |
| * file. |
| */ |
| if (!enableFsync || |
| sync_method == SYNC_METHOD_OPEN || |
| sync_method == SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC) |
| return; |
| |
| /* Measure I/O timing to sync the WAL file */ |
| if (track_wal_io_timing) |
| INSTR_TIME_SET_CURRENT(start); |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC); |
| switch (sync_method) |
| { |
| case SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC: |
| if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0) |
| msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m"); |
| break; |
| #ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH |
| case SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH: |
| if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0) |
| msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m"); |
| break; |
| #endif |
| #ifdef HAVE_FDATASYNC |
| case SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC: |
| if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0) |
| msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m"); |
| break; |
| #endif |
| case SYNC_METHOD_OPEN: |
| case SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC: |
| /* not reachable */ |
| Assert(false); |
| break; |
| default: |
| elog(PANIC, "unrecognized wal_sync_method: %d", sync_method); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* PANIC if failed to fsync */ |
| if (msg) |
| { |
| char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| int save_errno = errno; |
| |
| XLogFileName(xlogfname, ThisTimeLineID, segno, |
| wal_segment_size); |
| errno = save_errno; |
| ereport(PANIC, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg(msg, xlogfname))); |
| } |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Increment the I/O timing and the number of times WAL files were synced. |
| */ |
| if (track_wal_io_timing) |
| { |
| instr_time duration; |
| |
| INSTR_TIME_SET_CURRENT(duration); |
| INSTR_TIME_SUBTRACT(duration, start); |
| WalStats.m_wal_sync_time += INSTR_TIME_GET_MICROSEC(duration); |
| } |
| |
| WalStats.m_wal_sync++; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * do_pg_start_backup |
| * |
| * Utility function called at the start of an online backup. It creates the |
| * necessary starting checkpoint and constructs the backup label file. |
| * |
| * There are two kind of backups: exclusive and non-exclusive. An exclusive |
| * backup is started with pg_start_backup(), and there can be only one active |
| * at a time. The backup and tablespace map files of an exclusive backup are |
| * written to $PGDATA/backup_label and $PGDATA/tablespace_map, and they are |
| * removed by pg_stop_backup(). |
| * |
| * A non-exclusive backup is used for the streaming base backups (see |
| * src/backend/replication/basebackup.c). The difference to exclusive backups |
| * is that the backup label and tablespace map files are not written to disk. |
| * Instead, their would-be contents are returned in *labelfile and *tblspcmapfile, |
| * and the caller is responsible for including them in the backup archive as |
| * 'backup_label' and 'tablespace_map'. There can be many non-exclusive backups |
| * active at the same time, and they don't conflict with an exclusive backup |
| * either. |
| * |
| * labelfile and tblspcmapfile must be passed as NULL when starting an |
| * exclusive backup, and as initially-empty StringInfos for a non-exclusive |
| * backup. |
| * |
| * If "tablespaces" isn't NULL, it receives a list of tablespaceinfo structs |
| * describing the cluster's tablespaces. |
| * |
| * tblspcmapfile is required mainly for tar format in windows as native windows |
| * utilities are not able to create symlinks while extracting files from tar. |
| * However for consistency, the same is used for all platforms. |
| * |
| * Returns the minimum WAL location that must be present to restore from this |
| * backup, and the corresponding timeline ID in *starttli_p. |
| * |
| * Every successfully started non-exclusive backup must be stopped by calling |
| * do_pg_stop_backup() or do_pg_abort_backup(). |
| * |
| * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the |
| * permissions of the calling user! |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| do_pg_start_backup(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, TimeLineID *starttli_p, |
| StringInfo labelfile, List **tablespaces, |
| StringInfo tblspcmapfile) |
| { |
| bool exclusive = (labelfile == NULL); |
| bool backup_started_in_recovery = false; |
| XLogRecPtr checkpointloc; |
| XLogRecPtr startpoint; |
| TimeLineID starttli; |
| pg_time_t stamp_time; |
| char strfbuf[128]; |
| char xlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| XLogSegNo _logSegNo; |
| struct stat stat_buf; |
| FILE *fp; |
| |
| backup_started_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Currently only non-exclusive backup can be taken during recovery. |
| */ |
| if (backup_started_in_recovery && exclusive) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("recovery is in progress"), |
| errhint("WAL control functions cannot be executed during recovery."))); |
| |
| /* |
| * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL |
| * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery. |
| */ |
| if (!backup_started_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded()) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"), |
| errhint("wal_level must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start."))); |
| |
| if (strlen(backupidstr) > MAXPGPATH) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE), |
| errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)", |
| MAXPGPATH))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Mark backup active in shared memory. We must do full-page WAL writes |
| * during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because |
| * it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially |
| * written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with |
| * our write to the same page. This can be fixed as long as the first |
| * write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we |
| * turn on forcePageWrites and then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there |
| * are no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the |
| * backup is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record. (Once |
| * the backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore, |
| * since we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval |
| * must have been correctly captured by the backup.) |
| * |
| * Note that forcePageWrites has no effect during an online backup from |
| * the standby. |
| * |
| * We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of |
| * forcePageWrites, to ensure adequate interlocking against |
| * XLogInsertRecord(). |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| if (exclusive) |
| { |
| /* |
| * At first, mark that we're now starting an exclusive backup, to |
| * ensure that there are no other sessions currently running |
| * pg_start_backup() or pg_stop_backup(). |
| */ |
| if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState != EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE) |
| { |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("a backup is already in progress"), |
| errhint("Run pg_stop_backup() and try again."))); |
| } |
| XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STARTING; |
| } |
| else |
| XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups++; |
| XLogCtl->Insert.forcePageWrites = true; |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| |
| /* Ensure we release forcePageWrites if fail below */ |
| PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(pg_start_backup_callback, (Datum) BoolGetDatum(exclusive)); |
| { |
| bool gotUniqueStartpoint = false; |
| DIR *tblspcdir; |
| struct dirent *de; |
| tablespaceinfo *ti; |
| int datadirpathlen; |
| |
| /* |
| * Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the |
| * WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with |
| * old timeline IDs. That would otherwise happen if you called |
| * pg_start_backup() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the |
| * first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in |
| * the beginning with the old timeline ID. That can cause trouble at |
| * recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if |
| * pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL |
| * archive was cleared too before starting the backup. |
| * |
| * This also ensures that we have emitted a WAL page header that has |
| * XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE off before we emit the checkpoint record. |
| * Therefore, if a WAL archiver (such as pglesslog) is trying to |
| * compress out removable backup blocks, it won't remove any that |
| * occur after this point. |
| * |
| * During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that |
| * the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special |
| * recovery case described above. |
| */ |
| if (!backup_started_in_recovery) |
| RequestXLogSwitch(false); |
| |
| do |
| { |
| bool checkpointfpw; |
| |
| /* |
| * Force a CHECKPOINT. Aside from being necessary to prevent torn |
| * page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs |
| * will have different checkpoint positions and hence different |
| * history file names, even if nothing happened in between. |
| * |
| * During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use |
| * the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This |
| * means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint |
| * positions. |
| * |
| * Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_start_backup() |
| * during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use |
| * RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint. |
| * |
| * We use CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE only if requested by user (via |
| * passing fast = true). Otherwise this can take awhile. |
| */ |
| RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_FORCE | CHECKPOINT_WAIT | |
| (fast ? CHECKPOINT_IMMEDIATE : 0)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also |
| * its REDO pointer. The oldest point in WAL that would be needed |
| * to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO |
| * pointer. |
| */ |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED); |
| checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint; |
| startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo; |
| starttli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID; |
| checkpointfpw = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.fullPageWrites; |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| |
| if (backup_started_in_recovery) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| |
| /* |
| * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup |
| * (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting |
| * checkpoint) contain full-page writes. |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| if (!checkpointfpw || startpoint <= recptr) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("WAL generated with full_page_writes=off was replayed " |
| "since last restartpoint"), |
| errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby " |
| "is corrupt and should not be used. " |
| "Enable full_page_writes and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, " |
| "and then try an online backup again."))); |
| |
| /* |
| * During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL |
| * record and don't write the backup history file, the |
| * starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means |
| * that two base backups started at the same time might use |
| * the same checkpoint as starting locations. |
| */ |
| gotUniqueStartpoint = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender |
| * processes), we need to make sure that they use different |
| * checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting |
| * WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the |
| * end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history |
| * file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID |
| * for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but |
| * taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive |
| * either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet. |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < startpoint) |
| { |
| XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = startpoint; |
| gotUniqueStartpoint = true; |
| } |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| } while (!gotUniqueStartpoint); |
| |
| XLByteToSeg(startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| XLogFileName(xlogfilename, starttli, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* |
| * Construct tablespace_map file. If caller isn't interested in this, |
| * we make a local StringInfo. |
| */ |
| if (tblspcmapfile == NULL) |
| tblspcmapfile = makeStringInfo(); |
| |
| datadirpathlen = strlen(DataDir); |
| |
| /* Collect information about all tablespaces */ |
| tblspcdir = AllocateDir("pg_tblspc"); |
| while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, "pg_tblspc")) != NULL) |
| { |
| char fullpath[MAXPGPATH + 10]; |
| char linkpath[MAXPGPATH]; |
| char *relpath = NULL; |
| int rllen; |
| StringInfoData escapedpath; |
| char *s; |
| |
| /* Skip anything that doesn't look like a tablespace */ |
| if (strspn(de->d_name, "0123456789") != strlen(de->d_name)) |
| continue; |
| |
| snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "pg_tblspc/%s", de->d_name); |
| |
| #if defined(HAVE_READLINK) || defined(WIN32) |
| rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath)); |
| if (rllen < 0) |
| { |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m", |
| fullpath))); |
| continue; |
| } |
| else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath)) |
| { |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long", |
| fullpath))); |
| continue; |
| } |
| linkpath[rllen] = '\0'; |
| |
| /* |
| * Build a backslash-escaped version of the link path to include |
| * in the tablespace map file. |
| */ |
| initStringInfo(&escapedpath); |
| for (s = linkpath; *s; s++) |
| { |
| if (*s == '\n' || *s == '\r' || *s == '\\') |
| appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, '\\'); |
| appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, *s); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory |
| * when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located |
| * elsewhere. |
| */ |
| if (rllen > datadirpathlen && |
| strncmp(linkpath, DataDir, datadirpathlen) == 0 && |
| IS_DIR_SEP(linkpath[datadirpathlen])) |
| relpath = linkpath + datadirpathlen + 1; |
| |
| ti = palloc(sizeof(tablespaceinfo)); |
| ti->oid = pstrdup(de->d_name); |
| ti->path = pstrdup(linkpath); |
| ti->rpath = relpath ? pstrdup(relpath) : NULL; |
| ti->size = -1; |
| |
| if (tablespaces) |
| *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti); |
| |
| appendStringInfo(tblspcmapfile, "%s %s\n", |
| ti->oid, escapedpath.data); |
| |
| pfree(escapedpath.data); |
| #else |
| |
| /* |
| * If the platform does not have symbolic links, it should not be |
| * possible to have tablespaces - clearly somebody else created |
| * them. Warn about it and ignore. |
| */ |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_FEATURE_NOT_SUPPORTED), |
| errmsg("tablespaces are not supported on this platform"))); |
| #endif |
| } |
| FreeDir(tblspcdir); |
| |
| /* |
| * Construct backup label file. If caller isn't interested in this, |
| * we make a local StringInfo. |
| */ |
| if (labelfile == NULL) |
| labelfile = makeStringInfo(); |
| |
| /* Use the log timezone here, not the session timezone */ |
| stamp_time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| pg_strftime(strfbuf, sizeof(strfbuf), |
| "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z", |
| pg_localtime(&stamp_time, log_timezone)); |
| appendStringInfo(labelfile, "START WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %s)\n", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startpoint), xlogfilename); |
| appendStringInfo(labelfile, "CHECKPOINT LOCATION: %X/%X\n", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkpointloc)); |
| appendStringInfo(labelfile, "BACKUP METHOD: %s\n", |
| exclusive ? "pg_start_backup" : "streamed"); |
| appendStringInfo(labelfile, "BACKUP FROM: %s\n", |
| backup_started_in_recovery ? "standby" : "primary"); |
| appendStringInfo(labelfile, "START TIME: %s\n", strfbuf); |
| appendStringInfo(labelfile, "LABEL: %s\n", backupidstr); |
| appendStringInfo(labelfile, "START TIMELINE: %u\n", starttli); |
| |
| elogif(debug_basebackup, LOG, "basebackup label file --\n%s", labelfile->data); |
| |
| /* |
| * Okay, write the file, or return its contents to caller. |
| */ |
| if (exclusive) |
| { |
| /* |
| * Check for existing backup label --- implies a backup is already |
| * running. (XXX given that we checked exclusiveBackupState |
| * above, maybe it would be OK to just unlink any such label |
| * file?) |
| */ |
| if (stat(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, &stat_buf) != 0) |
| { |
| if (errno != ENOENT) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| } |
| else |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("a backup is already in progress"), |
| errhint("If you're sure there is no backup in progress, remove file \"%s\" and try again.", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| |
| fp = AllocateFile(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, "w"); |
| |
| if (!fp) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| if (fwrite(labelfile->data, labelfile->len, 1, fp) != 1 || |
| fflush(fp) != 0 || |
| pg_fsync(fileno(fp)) != 0 || |
| ferror(fp) || |
| FreeFile(fp)) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| /* Allocated locally for exclusive backups, so free separately */ |
| pfree(labelfile->data); |
| pfree(labelfile); |
| |
| /* Write backup tablespace_map file. */ |
| if (tblspcmapfile->len > 0) |
| { |
| if (stat(TABLESPACE_MAP, &stat_buf) != 0) |
| { |
| if (errno != ENOENT) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP))); |
| } |
| else |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("a backup is already in progress"), |
| errhint("If you're sure there is no backup in progress, remove file \"%s\" and try again.", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP))); |
| |
| fp = AllocateFile(TABLESPACE_MAP, "w"); |
| |
| if (!fp) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP))); |
| if (fwrite(tblspcmapfile->data, tblspcmapfile->len, 1, fp) != 1 || |
| fflush(fp) != 0 || |
| pg_fsync(fileno(fp)) != 0 || |
| ferror(fp) || |
| FreeFile(fp)) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP))); |
| } |
| |
| /* Allocated locally for exclusive backups, so free separately */ |
| pfree(tblspcmapfile->data); |
| pfree(tblspcmapfile); |
| } |
| } |
| PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(pg_start_backup_callback, (Datum) BoolGetDatum(exclusive)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Mark that start phase has correctly finished for an exclusive backup. |
| * Session-level locks are updated as well to reflect that state. |
| * |
| * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating backup |
| * counters and session-level lock. Otherwise they can be updated |
| * inconsistently, and which might cause do_pg_abort_backup() to fail. |
| */ |
| if (exclusive) |
| { |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS; |
| |
| /* Set session-level lock */ |
| sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_EXCLUSIVE; |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| } |
| else |
| sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NON_EXCLUSIVE; |
| |
| /* |
| * We're done. As a convenience, return the starting WAL location. |
| */ |
| if (starttli_p) |
| *starttli_p = starttli; |
| return startpoint; |
| } |
| |
| /* Error cleanup callback for pg_start_backup */ |
| static void |
| pg_start_backup_callback(int code, Datum arg) |
| { |
| bool exclusive = DatumGetBool(arg); |
| |
| /* Update backup counters and forcePageWrites on failure */ |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| if (exclusive) |
| { |
| Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STARTING); |
| XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups > 0); |
| XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups--; |
| } |
| |
| if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE && |
| XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups == 0) |
| { |
| XLogCtl->Insert.forcePageWrites = false; |
| } |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Error cleanup callback for pg_stop_backup |
| */ |
| static void |
| pg_stop_backup_callback(int code, Datum arg) |
| { |
| bool exclusive = DatumGetBool(arg); |
| |
| /* Update backup status on failure */ |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| if (exclusive) |
| { |
| Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STOPPING); |
| XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS; |
| } |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Utility routine to fetch the session-level status of a backup running. |
| */ |
| SessionBackupState |
| get_backup_status(void) |
| { |
| return sessionBackupState; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * do_pg_stop_backup |
| * |
| * Utility function called at the end of an online backup. It cleans up the |
| * backup state and can optionally wait for WAL segments to be archived. |
| * |
| * If labelfile is NULL, this stops an exclusive backup. Otherwise this stops |
| * the non-exclusive backup specified by 'labelfile'. |
| * |
| * Returns the last WAL location that must be present to restore from this |
| * backup, and the corresponding timeline ID in *stoptli_p. |
| * |
| * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the |
| * permissions of the calling user! |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| do_pg_stop_backup(char *labelfile, bool waitforarchive, TimeLineID *stoptli_p) |
| { |
| bool exclusive = (labelfile == NULL); |
| bool backup_started_in_recovery = false; |
| XLogRecPtr startpoint; |
| XLogRecPtr stoppoint; |
| TimeLineID stoptli; |
| pg_time_t stamp_time; |
| char strfbuf[128]; |
| char histfilepath[MAXPGPATH]; |
| char startxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| char stopxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| char lastxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| char histfilename[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| char backupfrom[20]; |
| XLogSegNo _logSegNo; |
| FILE *lfp; |
| FILE *fp; |
| char ch; |
| int seconds_before_warning; |
| int waits = 0; |
| bool reported_waiting = false; |
| char *remaining; |
| char *ptr; |
| uint32 hi, |
| lo; |
| |
| backup_started_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Currently only non-exclusive backup can be taken during recovery. |
| */ |
| if (backup_started_in_recovery && exclusive) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("recovery is in progress"), |
| errhint("WAL control functions cannot be executed during recovery."))); |
| |
| /* |
| * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL |
| * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery. |
| */ |
| if (!backup_started_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded()) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"), |
| errhint("wal_level must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start."))); |
| |
| if (exclusive) |
| { |
| /* |
| * At first, mark that we're now stopping an exclusive backup, to |
| * ensure that there are no other sessions currently running |
| * pg_start_backup() or pg_stop_backup(). |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState != EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_IN_PROGRESS) |
| { |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("exclusive backup not in progress"))); |
| } |
| XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_STOPPING; |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove backup_label. In case of failure, the state for an exclusive |
| * backup is switched back to in-progress. |
| */ |
| PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(pg_stop_backup_callback, (Datum) BoolGetDatum(exclusive)); |
| { |
| /* |
| * Read the existing label file into memory. |
| */ |
| struct stat statbuf; |
| int r; |
| |
| if (stat(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, &statbuf)) |
| { |
| /* should not happen per the upper checks */ |
| if (errno != ENOENT) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not stat file \"%s\": %m", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("a backup is not in progress"))); |
| } |
| |
| lfp = AllocateFile(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, "r"); |
| if (!lfp) |
| { |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| } |
| labelfile = palloc(statbuf.st_size + 1); |
| r = fread(labelfile, statbuf.st_size, 1, lfp); |
| labelfile[statbuf.st_size] = '\0'; |
| |
| /* |
| * Close and remove the backup label file |
| */ |
| if (r != 1 || ferror(lfp) || FreeFile(lfp)) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| durable_unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, ERROR); |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove tablespace_map file if present, it is created only if |
| * there are tablespaces. |
| */ |
| durable_unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP, DEBUG1); |
| } |
| PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(pg_stop_backup_callback, (Datum) BoolGetDatum(exclusive)); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * OK to update backup counters, forcePageWrites and session-level lock. |
| * |
| * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them. |
| * Otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, and which might cause |
| * do_pg_abort_backup() to fail. |
| */ |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| if (exclusive) |
| { |
| XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState = EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * The user-visible pg_start/stop_backup() functions that operate on |
| * exclusive backups can be called at any time, but for non-exclusive |
| * backups, it is expected that each do_pg_start_backup() call is |
| * matched by exactly one do_pg_stop_backup() call. |
| */ |
| Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups > 0); |
| XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups--; |
| } |
| |
| if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE && |
| XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups == 0) |
| { |
| XLogCtl->Insert.forcePageWrites = false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Clean up session-level lock. |
| * |
| * You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before |
| * cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need |
| * to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since |
| * CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be |
| * cleaned up before it. |
| */ |
| sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE; |
| |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Read and parse the START WAL LOCATION line (this code is pretty crude, |
| * but we are not expecting any variability in the file format). |
| */ |
| if (sscanf(labelfile, "START WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %24s)%c", |
| &hi, &lo, startxlogfilename, |
| &ch) != 4 || ch != '\n') |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| startpoint = ((uint64) hi) << 32 | lo; |
| remaining = strchr(labelfile, '\n') + 1; /* %n is not portable enough */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Parse the BACKUP FROM line. If we are taking an online backup from the |
| * standby, we confirm that the standby has not been promoted during the |
| * backup. |
| */ |
| ptr = strstr(remaining, "BACKUP FROM:"); |
| if (!ptr || sscanf(ptr, "BACKUP FROM: %19s\n", backupfrom) != 1) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| if (strcmp(backupfrom, "standby") == 0 && !backup_started_in_recovery) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"), |
| errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt " |
| "and should not be used. " |
| "Try taking another online backup."))); |
| |
| /* |
| * During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that |
| * pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be |
| * available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an |
| * end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether |
| * we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this |
| * backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last |
| * however. |
| * |
| * We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to |
| * wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is |
| * true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch |
| * the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an |
| * archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for |
| * them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are |
| * available. |
| * |
| * We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end |
| * location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end |
| * location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of |
| * pg_control. This is harmless for current uses. |
| * |
| * XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug |
| * purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore, |
| * even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because |
| * an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a |
| * backup history file during recovery. |
| */ |
| if (backup_started_in_recovery) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| |
| /* |
| * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain |
| * full-page writes. |
| */ |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| if (startpoint <= recptr) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("WAL generated with full_page_writes=off was replayed " |
| "during online backup"), |
| errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby " |
| "is corrupt and should not be used. " |
| "Enable full_page_writes and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, " |
| "and then try an online backup again."))); |
| |
| |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED); |
| stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint; |
| stoptli = ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI; |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* |
| * Write the backup-end xlog record |
| */ |
| XLogBeginInsert(); |
| XLogRegisterData((char *) (&startpoint), sizeof(startpoint)); |
| stoppoint = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_BACKUP_END); |
| stoptli = ThisTimeLineID; |
| |
| /* |
| * Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is |
| * valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file. |
| */ |
| RequestXLogSwitch(false); |
| |
| elog(LOG, "Basebackup stop point is at %X/%X.", |
| (uint32) (stoppoint >> 32), (uint32) stoppoint); |
| |
| XLByteToPrevSeg(stoppoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| XLogFileName(stopxlogfilename, stoptli, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* Use the log timezone here, not the session timezone */ |
| stamp_time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL); |
| pg_strftime(strfbuf, sizeof(strfbuf), |
| "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z", |
| pg_localtime(&stamp_time, log_timezone)); |
| |
| /* |
| * Write the backup history file |
| */ |
| XLByteToSeg(startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| BackupHistoryFilePath(histfilepath, stoptli, _logSegNo, |
| startpoint, wal_segment_size); |
| fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w"); |
| if (!fp) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", |
| histfilepath))); |
| fprintf(fp, "START WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %s)\n", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startpoint), startxlogfilename); |
| fprintf(fp, "STOP WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %s)\n", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(stoppoint), stopxlogfilename); |
| |
| /* |
| * Transfer remaining lines including label and start timeline to |
| * history file. |
| */ |
| fprintf(fp, "%s", remaining); |
| fprintf(fp, "STOP TIME: %s\n", strfbuf); |
| fprintf(fp, "STOP TIMELINE: %u\n", stoptli); |
| if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp)) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m", |
| histfilepath))); |
| |
| /* |
| * Clean out any no-longer-needed history files. As a side effect, |
| * this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file, |
| * notifying the archiver that history file may be archived |
| * immediately. |
| */ |
| CleanupBackupHistory(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be |
| * archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL |
| * needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with |
| * wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like |
| * polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge |
| * of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all |
| * the required WAL. |
| * |
| * We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the |
| * history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting |
| * property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely |
| * archived as well. |
| * |
| * We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we |
| * assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't |
| * wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false, |
| * or you can set statement_timeout. Also, some notices are issued to |
| * clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively. |
| */ |
| |
| if (waitforarchive && |
| ((!backup_started_in_recovery && XLogArchivingActive()) || |
| (backup_started_in_recovery && XLogArchivingAlways()))) |
| { |
| XLByteToPrevSeg(stoppoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| XLogFileName(lastxlogfilename, stoptli, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| XLByteToSeg(startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| BackupHistoryFileName(histfilename, stoptli, _logSegNo, |
| startpoint, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| seconds_before_warning = 60; |
| waits = 0; |
| |
| while (XLogArchiveIsBusy(lastxlogfilename) || |
| XLogArchiveIsBusy(histfilename)) |
| { |
| CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS(); |
| |
| if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5) |
| { |
| ereport(NOTICE, |
| (errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived"))); |
| reported_waiting = true; |
| } |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_BACKUP_WAIT_WAL_ARCHIVE); |
| pg_usleep(1000000L); |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| if (++waits >= seconds_before_warning) |
| { |
| seconds_before_warning *= 2; /* This wraps in >10 years... */ |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)", |
| waits), |
| errhint("Check that your archive_command is executing properly. " |
| "You can safely cancel this backup, " |
| "but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments."))); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| ereport(NOTICE, |
| (errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived"))); |
| } |
| else if (waitforarchive) |
| ereport(NOTICE, |
| (errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup"))); |
| |
| /* |
| * We're done. As a convenience, return the ending WAL location. |
| */ |
| if (stoptli_p) |
| *stoptli_p = stoptli; |
| return stoppoint; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* |
| * do_pg_abort_backup: abort a running backup |
| * |
| * This does just the most basic steps of do_pg_stop_backup(), by taking the |
| * system out of backup mode, thus making it a lot more safe to call from |
| * an error handler. |
| * |
| * The caller can pass 'arg' as 'true' or 'false' to control whether a warning |
| * is emitted. |
| * |
| * NB: This is only for aborting a non-exclusive backup that doesn't write |
| * backup_label. A backup started with pg_start_backup() needs to be finished |
| * with pg_stop_backup(). |
| * |
| * NB: This gets used as a before_shmem_exit handler, hence the odd-looking |
| * signature. |
| */ |
| void |
| do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg) |
| { |
| bool emit_warning = DatumGetBool(arg); |
| |
| /* |
| * Quick exit if session is not keeping around a non-exclusive backup |
| * already started. |
| */ |
| if (sessionBackupState != SESSION_BACKUP_NON_EXCLUSIVE) |
| return; |
| |
| WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(); |
| Assert(XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups > 0); |
| XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups--; |
| |
| if (XLogCtl->Insert.exclusiveBackupState == EXCLUSIVE_BACKUP_NONE && |
| XLogCtl->Insert.nonExclusiveBackups == 0) |
| { |
| XLogCtl->Insert.forcePageWrites = false; |
| } |
| |
| sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE; |
| WALInsertLockRelease(); |
| |
| if (emit_warning) |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_stop_backup was called"))); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Register a handler that will warn about unterminated backups at end of |
| * session, unless this has already been done. |
| */ |
| void |
| register_persistent_abort_backup_handler(void) |
| { |
| static bool already_done = false; |
| |
| if (already_done) |
| return; |
| before_shmem_exit(do_pg_abort_backup, DatumGetBool(true)); |
| already_done = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get latest redo apply position. |
| * |
| * Exported to allow WALReceiver to read the pointer directly. |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| GetXLogReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayTLI) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| TimeLineID tli; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| recptr = XLogCtl->lastReplayedEndRecPtr; |
| tli = XLogCtl->lastReplayedTLI; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| if (replayTLI) |
| *replayTLI = tli; |
| return recptr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get latest WAL insert pointer |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void) |
| { |
| XLogCtlInsert *Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert; |
| uint64 current_bytepos; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck); |
| current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos; |
| SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck); |
| |
| return XLogBytePosToRecPtr(current_bytepos); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Get latest WAL write pointer |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| LogwrtResult = XLogCtl->LogwrtResult; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return LogwrtResult.Write; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns the redo pointer of the last checkpoint or restartpoint. This is |
| * the oldest point in WAL that we still need, if we have to restart recovery. |
| */ |
| void |
| GetOldestRestartPoint(XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli) |
| { |
| LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED); |
| *oldrecptr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo; |
| *oldtli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID; |
| LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * read_backup_label: check to see if a backup_label file is present |
| * |
| * If we see a backup_label during recovery, we assume that we are recovering |
| * from a backup dump file, and we therefore roll forward from the checkpoint |
| * identified by the label file, NOT what pg_control says. This avoids the |
| * problem that pg_control might have been archived one or more checkpoints |
| * later than the start of the dump, and so if we rely on it as the start |
| * point, we will fail to restore a consistent database state. |
| * |
| * Returns true if a backup_label was found (and fills the checkpoint |
| * location and its REDO location into *checkPointLoc and RedoStartLSN, |
| * respectively); returns false if not. If this backup_label came from a |
| * streamed backup, *backupEndRequired is set to true. If this backup_label |
| * was created during recovery, *backupFromStandby is set to true. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| read_backup_label(XLogRecPtr *checkPointLoc, bool *backupEndRequired, |
| bool *backupFromStandby) |
| { |
| char startxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| TimeLineID tli_from_walseg, |
| tli_from_file; |
| FILE *lfp; |
| char ch; |
| char backuptype[20]; |
| char backupfrom[20]; |
| char backuplabel[MAXPGPATH]; |
| char backuptime[128]; |
| uint32 hi, |
| lo; |
| |
| *backupEndRequired = false; |
| *backupFromStandby = false; |
| |
| /* |
| * See if label file is present |
| */ |
| lfp = AllocateFile(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, "r"); |
| if (!lfp) |
| { |
| if (errno != ENOENT) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| return false; /* it's not there, all is fine */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Read and parse the START WAL LOCATION and CHECKPOINT lines (this code |
| * is pretty crude, but we are not expecting any variability in the file |
| * format). |
| */ |
| if (fscanf(lfp, "START WAL LOCATION: %X/%X (file %08X%16s)%c", |
| &hi, &lo, &tli_from_walseg, startxlogfilename, &ch) != 5 || ch != '\n') |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| RedoStartLSN = ((uint64) hi) << 32 | lo; |
| if (fscanf(lfp, "CHECKPOINT LOCATION: %X/%X%c", |
| &hi, &lo, &ch) != 3 || ch != '\n') |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| *checkPointLoc = ((uint64) hi) << 32 | lo; |
| |
| /* |
| * BACKUP METHOD and BACKUP FROM lines are new in 9.2. We can't restore |
| * from an older backup anyway, but since the information on it is not |
| * strictly required, don't error out if it's missing for some reason. |
| */ |
| if (fscanf(lfp, "BACKUP METHOD: %19s\n", backuptype) == 1) |
| { |
| if (strcmp(backuptype, "streamed") == 0) |
| *backupEndRequired = true; |
| } |
| |
| if (fscanf(lfp, "BACKUP FROM: %19s\n", backupfrom) == 1) |
| { |
| if (strcmp(backupfrom, "standby") == 0) |
| *backupFromStandby = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Parse START TIME and LABEL. Those are not mandatory fields for recovery |
| * but checking for their presence is useful for debugging and the next |
| * sanity checks. Cope also with the fact that the result buffers have a |
| * pre-allocated size, hence if the backup_label file has been generated |
| * with strings longer than the maximum assumed here an incorrect parsing |
| * happens. That's fine as only minor consistency checks are done |
| * afterwards. |
| */ |
| if (fscanf(lfp, "START TIME: %127[^\n]\n", backuptime) == 1) |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("backup time %s in file \"%s\"", |
| backuptime, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| |
| if (fscanf(lfp, "LABEL: %1023[^\n]\n", backuplabel) == 1) |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("backup label %s in file \"%s\"", |
| backuplabel, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| |
| /* |
| * START TIMELINE is new as of 11. Its parsing is not mandatory, still use |
| * it as a sanity check if present. |
| */ |
| if (fscanf(lfp, "START TIMELINE: %u\n", &tli_from_file) == 1) |
| { |
| if (tli_from_walseg != tli_from_file) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", BACKUP_LABEL_FILE), |
| errdetail("Timeline ID parsed is %u, but expected %u.", |
| tli_from_file, tli_from_walseg))); |
| |
| ereport(DEBUG1, |
| (errmsg_internal("backup timeline %u in file \"%s\"", |
| tli_from_file, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| } |
| |
| if (ferror(lfp) || FreeFile(lfp)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE))); |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * read_tablespace_map: check to see if a tablespace_map file is present |
| * |
| * If we see a tablespace_map file during recovery, we assume that we are |
| * recovering from a backup dump file, and we therefore need to create symlinks |
| * as per the information present in tablespace_map file. |
| * |
| * Returns true if a tablespace_map file was found (and fills *tablespaces |
| * with a tablespaceinfo struct for each tablespace listed in the file); |
| * returns false if not. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| read_tablespace_map(List **tablespaces) |
| { |
| tablespaceinfo *ti; |
| FILE *lfp; |
| char str[MAXPGPATH]; |
| int ch, |
| i, |
| n; |
| bool was_backslash; |
| |
| /* |
| * See if tablespace_map file is present |
| */ |
| lfp = AllocateFile(TABLESPACE_MAP, "r"); |
| if (!lfp) |
| { |
| if (errno != ENOENT) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP))); |
| return false; /* it's not there, all is fine */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Read and parse the link name and path lines from tablespace_map file |
| * (this code is pretty crude, but we are not expecting any variability in |
| * the file format). De-escape any backslashes that were inserted. |
| */ |
| i = 0; |
| was_backslash = false; |
| while ((ch = fgetc(lfp)) != EOF) |
| { |
| if (!was_backslash && (ch == '\n' || ch == '\r')) |
| { |
| if (i == 0) |
| continue; /* \r immediately followed by \n */ |
| |
| /* |
| * The de-escaped line should contain an OID followed by exactly |
| * one space followed by a path. The path might start with |
| * spaces, so don't be too liberal about parsing. |
| */ |
| str[i] = '\0'; |
| n = 0; |
| while (str[n] && str[n] != ' ') |
| n++; |
| if (n < 1 || n >= i - 1) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", TABLESPACE_MAP))); |
| str[n++] = '\0'; |
| |
| ti = palloc0(sizeof(tablespaceinfo)); |
| ti->oid = pstrdup(str); |
| ti->path = pstrdup(str + n); |
| *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti); |
| |
| i = 0; |
| continue; |
| } |
| else if (!was_backslash && ch == '\\') |
| was_backslash = true; |
| else |
| { |
| if (i < sizeof(str) - 1) |
| str[i++] = ch; |
| was_backslash = false; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (i != 0 || was_backslash) /* last line not terminated? */ |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE), |
| errmsg("invalid data in file \"%s\"", TABLESPACE_MAP))); |
| |
| if (ferror(lfp) || FreeFile(lfp)) |
| ereport(FATAL, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m", |
| TABLESPACE_MAP))); |
| |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Error context callback for errors occurring during rm_redo(). |
| */ |
| static void |
| rm_redo_error_callback(void *arg) |
| { |
| XLogReaderState *record = (XLogReaderState *) arg; |
| StringInfoData buf; |
| |
| initStringInfo(&buf); |
| xlog_outdesc(&buf, record); |
| xlog_block_info(&buf, record); |
| |
| /* translator: %s is a WAL record description */ |
| errcontext("WAL redo at %X/%X for %s", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record->ReadRecPtr), |
| buf.data); |
| |
| pfree(buf.data); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * BackupInProgress: check if online backup mode is active |
| * |
| * This is done by checking for existence of the "backup_label" file. |
| */ |
| bool |
| BackupInProgress(void) |
| { |
| struct stat stat_buf; |
| |
| return (stat(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * CancelBackup: rename the "backup_label" and "tablespace_map" |
| * files to cancel backup mode |
| * |
| * If the "backup_label" file exists, it will be renamed to "backup_label.old". |
| * Similarly, if the "tablespace_map" file exists, it will be renamed to |
| * "tablespace_map.old". |
| * |
| * Note that this will render an online backup in progress |
| * useless. To correctly finish an online backup, pg_stop_backup must be |
| * called. |
| */ |
| void |
| CancelBackup(void) |
| { |
| struct stat stat_buf; |
| |
| /* if the backup_label file is not there, return */ |
| if (stat(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, &stat_buf) < 0) |
| return; |
| |
| /* remove leftover file from previously canceled backup if it exists */ |
| unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_OLD); |
| |
| if (durable_rename(BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, DEBUG1) != 0) |
| { |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("online backup mode was not canceled"), |
| errdetail("File \"%s\" could not be renamed to \"%s\": %m.", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD))); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* if the tablespace_map file is not there, return */ |
| if (stat(TABLESPACE_MAP, &stat_buf) < 0) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("online backup mode canceled"), |
| errdetail("File \"%s\" was renamed to \"%s\".", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD))); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* remove leftover file from previously canceled backup if it exists */ |
| unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD); |
| |
| if (durable_rename(TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, DEBUG1) == 0) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("online backup mode canceled"), |
| errdetail("Files \"%s\" and \"%s\" were renamed to " |
| "\"%s\" and \"%s\", respectively.", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, TABLESPACE_MAP, |
| BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD))); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| ereport(WARNING, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("online backup mode canceled"), |
| errdetail("File \"%s\" was renamed to \"%s\", but " |
| "file \"%s\" could not be renamed to \"%s\": %m.", |
| BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, |
| TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD))); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Read the XLOG page containing RecPtr into readBuf (if not read already). |
| * Returns number of bytes read, if the page is read successfully, or -1 |
| * in case of errors. When errors occur, they are ereport'ed, but only |
| * if they have not been previously reported. |
| * |
| * This is responsible for restoring files from archive as needed, as well |
| * as for waiting for the requested WAL record to arrive in standby mode. |
| * |
| * 'emode' specifies the log level used for reporting "file not found" or |
| * "end of WAL" situations in archive recovery, or in standby mode when a |
| * trigger file is found. If set to WARNING or below, XLogPageRead() returns |
| * false in those situations, on higher log levels the ereport() won't |
| * return. |
| * |
| * In standby mode, if after a successful return of XLogPageRead() the |
| * caller finds the record it's interested in to be broken, it should |
| * ereport the error with the level determined by |
| * emode_for_corrupt_record(), and then set lastSourceFailed |
| * and call XLogPageRead() again with the same arguments. This lets |
| * XLogPageRead() to try fetching the record from another source, or to |
| * sleep and retry. |
| */ |
| static int |
| XLogPageRead(XLogReaderState *xlogreader, XLogRecPtr targetPagePtr, int reqLen, |
| XLogRecPtr targetRecPtr, char *readBuf) |
| { |
| XLogPageReadPrivate *private = |
| (XLogPageReadPrivate *) xlogreader->private_data; |
| int emode = private->emode; |
| uint32 targetPageOff; |
| XLogSegNo targetSegNo PG_USED_FOR_ASSERTS_ONLY; |
| int r; |
| |
| XLByteToSeg(targetPagePtr, targetSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| targetPageOff = XLogSegmentOffset(targetPagePtr, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| /* |
| * See if we need to switch to a new segment because the requested record |
| * is not in the currently open one. |
| */ |
| if (readFile >= 0 && |
| !XLByteInSeg(targetPagePtr, readSegNo, wal_segment_size)) |
| { |
| elogif(debug_xlog_record_read, LOG, |
| "xlog page read -- Requested record %X/%X does not exist in" |
| "current read xlog file (readsegno " UINT64_FORMAT ")", |
| (uint32) (targetRecPtr >> 32), (uint32) targetRecPtr, |
| readSegNo); |
| |
| /* |
| * Request a restartpoint if we've replayed too much xlog since the |
| * last one. |
| */ |
| if (bgwriterLaunched) |
| { |
| if (XLogCheckpointNeeded(readSegNo)) |
| { |
| (void) GetRedoRecPtr(); |
| if (XLogCheckpointNeeded(readSegNo)) |
| RequestCheckpoint(CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| close(readFile); |
| readFile = -1; |
| readSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY; |
| } |
| |
| XLByteToSeg(targetPagePtr, readSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| |
| elogif(debug_xlog_record_read, LOG, |
| "xlog page read -- Requested record %X/%X has " |
| "targetsegno " UINT64_FORMAT ", targetpageoff %u", |
| (uint32) (targetRecPtr >> 32), (uint32) targetRecPtr, |
| readSegNo, targetPageOff); |
| |
| retry: |
| /* See if we need to retrieve more data */ |
| if (readFile < 0 || |
| (readSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM && |
| flushedUpto < targetPagePtr + reqLen)) |
| { |
| if (!WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable(targetPagePtr + reqLen, |
| private->randAccess, |
| private->fetching_ckpt, |
| targetRecPtr)) |
| { |
| if (readFile >= 0) |
| close(readFile); |
| readFile = -1; |
| readLen = 0; |
| readSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY; |
| |
| return -1; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * At this point, we have the right segment open and if we're streaming we |
| * know the requested record is in it. |
| */ |
| Assert(readFile != -1); |
| |
| /* |
| * If the current segment is being streamed from the primary, calculate |
| * how much of the current page we have received already. We know the |
| * requested record has been received, but this is for the benefit of |
| * future calls, to allow quick exit at the top of this function. |
| */ |
| if (readSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM) |
| { |
| if (((targetPagePtr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) != (flushedUpto / XLOG_BLCKSZ)) |
| readLen = XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| else |
| readLen = XLogSegmentOffset(flushedUpto, wal_segment_size) - |
| targetPageOff; |
| } |
| else |
| readLen = XLOG_BLCKSZ; |
| |
| /* Read the requested page */ |
| readOff = targetPageOff; |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_READ); |
| r = pg_pread(readFile, readBuf, XLOG_BLCKSZ, (off_t) readOff); |
| if (r != XLOG_BLCKSZ) |
| { |
| char fname[MAXFNAMELEN]; |
| int save_errno = errno; |
| |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| XLogFileName(fname, curFileTLI, readSegNo, wal_segment_size); |
| if (r < 0) |
| { |
| errno = save_errno; |
| ereport(emode_for_corrupt_record(emode, targetPagePtr + reqLen), |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not read from log segment %s, offset %u: %m", |
| fname, readOff))); |
| } |
| else |
| ereport(emode_for_corrupt_record(emode, targetPagePtr + reqLen), |
| (errcode(ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED), |
| errmsg("could not read from log segment %s, offset %u: read %d of %zu", |
| fname, readOff, r, (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ))); |
| goto next_record_is_invalid; |
| } |
| pgstat_report_wait_end(); |
| |
| Assert(targetSegNo == readSegNo); |
| Assert(targetPageOff == readOff); |
| Assert(reqLen <= readLen); |
| |
| xlogreader->seg.ws_tli = curFileTLI; |
| |
| /* |
| * Check the page header immediately, so that we can retry immediately if |
| * it's not valid. This may seem unnecessary, because XLogReadRecord() |
| * validates the page header anyway, and would propagate the failure up to |
| * ReadRecord(), which would retry. However, there's a corner case with |
| * continuation records, if a record is split across two pages such that |
| * we would need to read the two pages from different sources. For |
| * example, imagine a scenario where a streaming replica is started up, |
| * and replay reaches a record that's split across two WAL segments. The |
| * first page is only available locally, in pg_wal, because it's already |
| * been recycled on the primary. The second page, however, is not present |
| * in pg_wal, and we should stream it from the primary. There is a |
| * recycled WAL segment present in pg_wal, with garbage contents, however. |
| * We would read the first page from the local WAL segment, but when |
| * reading the second page, we would read the bogus, recycled, WAL |
| * segment. If we didn't catch that case here, we would never recover, |
| * because ReadRecord() would retry reading the whole record from the |
| * beginning. |
| * |
| * Of course, this only catches errors in the page header, which is what |
| * happens in the case of a recycled WAL segment. Other kinds of errors or |
| * corruption still has the same problem. But this at least fixes the |
| * common case, which can happen as part of normal operation. |
| * |
| * Validating the page header is cheap enough that doing it twice |
| * shouldn't be a big deal from a performance point of view. |
| */ |
| if (!XLogReaderValidatePageHeader(xlogreader, targetPagePtr, readBuf)) |
| { |
| /* reset any error XLogReaderValidatePageHeader() might have set */ |
| xlogreader->errormsg_buf[0] = '\0'; |
| goto next_record_is_invalid; |
| } |
| |
| return readLen; |
| |
| next_record_is_invalid: |
| lastSourceFailed = true; |
| |
| if (readFile >= 0) |
| close(readFile); |
| readFile = -1; |
| readLen = 0; |
| readSource = XLOG_FROM_ANY; |
| |
| /* In standby-mode, keep trying */ |
| if (StandbyMode) |
| goto retry; |
| else |
| return -1; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Open the WAL segment containing WAL location 'RecPtr'. |
| * |
| * The segment can be fetched via restore_command, or via walreceiver having |
| * streamed the record, or it can already be present in pg_wal. Checking |
| * pg_wal is mainly for crash recovery, but it will be polled in standby mode |
| * too, in case someone copies a new segment directly to pg_wal. That is not |
| * documented or recommended, though. |
| * |
| * If 'fetching_ckpt' is true, we're fetching a checkpoint record, and should |
| * prepare to read WAL starting from RedoStartLSN after this. |
| * |
| * 'RecPtr' might not point to the beginning of the record we're interested |
| * in, it might also point to the page or segment header. In that case, |
| * 'tliRecPtr' is the position of the WAL record we're interested in. It is |
| * used to decide which timeline to stream the requested WAL from. |
| * |
| * If the record is not immediately available, the function returns false |
| * if we're not in standby mode. In standby mode, waits for it to become |
| * available. |
| * |
| * When the requested record becomes available, the function opens the file |
| * containing it (if not open already), and returns true. When end of standby |
| * mode is triggered by the user, and there is no more WAL available, returns |
| * false. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable(XLogRecPtr RecPtr, bool randAccess, |
| bool fetching_ckpt, XLogRecPtr tliRecPtr) |
| { |
| static TimestampTz last_fail_time = 0; |
| TimestampTz now; |
| bool streaming_reply_sent = false; |
| |
| /*------- |
| * Standby mode is implemented by a state machine: |
| * |
| * 1. Read from either archive or pg_wal (XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE), or just |
| * pg_wal (XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL) |
| * 2. Check trigger file |
| * 3. Read from primary server via walreceiver (XLOG_FROM_STREAM) |
| * 4. Rescan timelines |
| * 5. Sleep wal_retrieve_retry_interval milliseconds, and loop back to 1. |
| * |
| * Failure to read from the current source advances the state machine to |
| * the next state. |
| * |
| * 'currentSource' indicates the current state. There are no currentSource |
| * values for "check trigger", "rescan timelines", and "sleep" states, |
| * those actions are taken when reading from the previous source fails, as |
| * part of advancing to the next state. |
| * |
| * If standby mode is turned off while reading WAL from stream, we move |
| * to XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE and reset lastSourceFailed, to force fetching |
| * the files (which would be required at end of recovery, e.g., timeline |
| * history file) from archive or pg_wal. We don't need to kill WAL receiver |
| * here because it's already stopped when standby mode is turned off at |
| * the end of recovery. |
| *------- |
| */ |
| if (!InArchiveRecovery) |
| currentSource = XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL; |
| else if (currentSource == XLOG_FROM_ANY || |
| (!StandbyMode && currentSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM)) |
| { |
| lastSourceFailed = false; |
| currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE; |
| } |
| |
| for (;;) |
| { |
| XLogSource oldSource = currentSource; |
| bool startWalReceiver = false; |
| |
| /* |
| * First check if we failed to read from the current source, and |
| * advance the state machine if so. The failure to read might've |
| * happened outside this function, e.g when a CRC check fails on a |
| * record, or within this loop. |
| */ |
| if (lastSourceFailed) |
| { |
| switch (currentSource) |
| { |
| case XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE: |
| case XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL: |
| |
| /* |
| * Check to see if the trigger file exists. Note that we |
| * do this only after failure, so when you create the |
| * trigger file, we still finish replaying as much as we |
| * can from archive and pg_wal before failover. |
| */ |
| if (StandbyMode && CheckForStandbyTrigger()) |
| { |
| ShutdownWalRcv(); |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Not in standby mode, and we've now tried the archive |
| * and pg_wal. |
| */ |
| if (!StandbyMode) |
| return false; |
| |
| /* |
| * Move to XLOG_FROM_STREAM state, and set to start a |
| * walreceiver if necessary. |
| */ |
| currentSource = XLOG_FROM_STREAM; |
| startWalReceiver = true; |
| break; |
| |
| case XLOG_FROM_STREAM: |
| |
| /* |
| * Failure while streaming. Most likely, we got here |
| * because streaming replication was terminated, or |
| * promotion was triggered. But we also get here if we |
| * find an invalid record in the WAL streamed from the |
| * primary, in which case something is seriously wrong. |
| * There's little chance that the problem will just go |
| * away, but PANIC is not good for availability either, |
| * especially in hot standby mode. So, we treat that the |
| * same as disconnection, and retry from archive/pg_wal |
| * again. The WAL in the archive should be identical to |
| * what was streamed, so it's unlikely that it helps, but |
| * one can hope... |
| */ |
| |
| /* |
| * We should be able to move to XLOG_FROM_STREAM only in |
| * standby mode. |
| */ |
| Assert(StandbyMode); |
| |
| /* |
| * Before we leave XLOG_FROM_STREAM state, make sure that |
| * walreceiver is not active, so that it won't overwrite |
| * WAL that we restore from archive. |
| */ |
| if (WalRcvStreaming()) |
| ShutdownWalRcv(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Before we sleep, re-scan for possible new timelines if |
| * we were requested to recover to the latest timeline. |
| */ |
| if (recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal == RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_LATEST) |
| { |
| if (rescanLatestTimeLine()) |
| { |
| currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE; |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * XLOG_FROM_STREAM is the last state in our state |
| * machine, so we've exhausted all the options for |
| * obtaining the requested WAL. We're going to loop back |
| * and retry from the archive, but if it hasn't been long |
| * since last attempt, sleep wal_retrieve_retry_interval |
| * milliseconds to avoid busy-waiting. |
| */ |
| now = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| if (!TimestampDifferenceExceeds(last_fail_time, now, |
| wal_retrieve_retry_interval)) |
| { |
| long wait_time; |
| |
| wait_time = wal_retrieve_retry_interval - |
| TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(last_fail_time, now); |
| |
| (void) WaitLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch, |
| WL_LATCH_SET | WL_TIMEOUT | |
| WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH, |
| wait_time, |
| WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_RETRIEVE_RETRY_INTERVAL); |
| ResetLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch); |
| now = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| |
| /* Handle interrupt signals of startup process */ |
| HandleStartupProcInterrupts(); |
| } |
| last_fail_time = now; |
| currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE; |
| break; |
| |
| default: |
| elog(ERROR, "unexpected WAL source %d", currentSource); |
| } |
| } |
| else if (currentSource == XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We just successfully read a file in pg_wal. We prefer files in |
| * the archive over ones in pg_wal, so try the next file again |
| * from the archive first. |
| */ |
| if (InArchiveRecovery) |
| currentSource = XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE; |
| } |
| |
| if (currentSource != oldSource) |
| elog(DEBUG2, "switched WAL source from %s to %s after %s", |
| xlogSourceNames[oldSource], xlogSourceNames[currentSource], |
| lastSourceFailed ? "failure" : "success"); |
| |
| /* |
| * We've now handled possible failure. Try to read from the chosen |
| * source. |
| */ |
| lastSourceFailed = false; |
| |
| switch (currentSource) |
| { |
| case XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE: |
| case XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL: |
| |
| /* |
| * WAL receiver must not be running when reading WAL from |
| * archive or pg_wal. |
| */ |
| Assert(!WalRcvStreaming()); |
| |
| /* Close any old file we might have open. */ |
| if (readFile >= 0) |
| { |
| close(readFile); |
| readFile = -1; |
| } |
| /* Reset curFileTLI if random fetch. */ |
| if (randAccess) |
| curFileTLI = 0; |
| |
| /* |
| * Try to restore the file from archive, or read an existing |
| * file from pg_wal. |
| */ |
| readFile = XLogFileReadAnyTLI(readSegNo, DEBUG2, |
| currentSource == XLOG_FROM_ARCHIVE ? XLOG_FROM_ANY : |
| currentSource); |
| if (readFile >= 0) |
| return true; /* success! */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Nope, not found in archive or pg_wal. |
| */ |
| lastSourceFailed = true; |
| break; |
| |
| case XLOG_FROM_STREAM: |
| { |
| bool havedata; |
| |
| /* |
| * We should be able to move to XLOG_FROM_STREAM only in |
| * standby mode. |
| */ |
| Assert(StandbyMode); |
| |
| /* |
| * First, shutdown walreceiver if its restart has been |
| * requested -- but no point if we're already slated for |
| * starting it. |
| */ |
| if (pendingWalRcvRestart && !startWalReceiver) |
| { |
| ShutdownWalRcv(); |
| |
| /* |
| * Re-scan for possible new timelines if we were |
| * requested to recover to the latest timeline. |
| */ |
| if (recoveryTargetTimeLineGoal == |
| RECOVERY_TARGET_TIMELINE_LATEST) |
| rescanLatestTimeLine(); |
| |
| startWalReceiver = true; |
| } |
| pendingWalRcvRestart = false; |
| |
| /* |
| * Launch walreceiver if needed. |
| * |
| * If fetching_ckpt is true, RecPtr points to the initial |
| * checkpoint location. In that case, we use RedoStartLSN |
| * as the streaming start position instead of RecPtr, so |
| * that when we later jump backwards to start redo at |
| * RedoStartLSN, we will have the logs streamed already. |
| */ |
| if (startWalReceiver && |
| PrimaryConnInfo && strcmp(PrimaryConnInfo, "") != 0) |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr ptr; |
| TimeLineID tli; |
| |
| if (fetching_ckpt) |
| { |
| ptr = RedoStartLSN; |
| tli = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.ThisTimeLineID; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| ptr = RecPtr; |
| |
| /* |
| * Use the record begin position to determine the |
| * TLI, rather than the position we're reading. |
| */ |
| tli = tliOfPointInHistory(tliRecPtr, expectedTLEs); |
| |
| if (curFileTLI > 0 && tli < curFileTLI) |
| elog(ERROR, "according to history file, WAL location %X/%X belongs to timeline %u, but previous recovered WAL file came from timeline %u", |
| LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(tliRecPtr), |
| tli, curFileTLI); |
| } |
| curFileTLI = tli; |
| RequestXLogStreaming(tli, ptr, PrimaryConnInfo, |
| PrimarySlotName, |
| wal_receiver_create_temp_slot); |
| flushedUpto = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check if WAL receiver is active or wait to start up. |
| */ |
| if (!WalRcvStreaming()) |
| { |
| elogif(debug_xlog_record_read, LOG, |
| "xlog page read -- Xlog from stream is a failed" |
| "source, hence requesting walreceiver shutdown."); |
| |
| lastSourceFailed = true; |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Walreceiver is active, so see if new data has arrived. |
| * |
| * We only advance XLogReceiptTime when we obtain fresh |
| * WAL from walreceiver and observe that we had already |
| * processed everything before the most recent "chunk" |
| * that it flushed to disk. In steady state where we are |
| * keeping up with the incoming data, XLogReceiptTime will |
| * be updated on each cycle. When we are behind, |
| * XLogReceiptTime will not advance, so the grace time |
| * allotted to conflicting queries will decrease. |
| */ |
| if (RecPtr < flushedUpto) |
| havedata = true; |
| else |
| { |
| XLogRecPtr latestChunkStart; |
| |
| flushedUpto = GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(&latestChunkStart, &receiveTLI); |
| if (RecPtr < flushedUpto && receiveTLI == curFileTLI) |
| { |
| havedata = true; |
| if (latestChunkStart <= RecPtr) |
| { |
| XLogReceiptTime = GetCurrentTimestamp(); |
| SetCurrentChunkStartTime(XLogReceiptTime); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| havedata = false; |
| } |
| if (havedata) |
| { |
| elogif(debug_xlog_record_read, LOG, |
| "xlog page read -- There is enough xlog data to be " |
| "read (flushedUpto %X/%X, requestedrec %X/%X)", |
| (uint32) (flushedUpto >> 32), (uint32) flushedUpto, |
| (uint32) (RecPtr >> 32), (uint32) RecPtr); |
| |
| /* |
| * Great, streamed far enough. Open the file if it's |
| * not open already. Also read the timeline history |
| * file if we haven't initialized timeline history |
| * yet; it should be streamed over and present in |
| * pg_wal by now. Use XLOG_FROM_STREAM so that source |
| * info is set correctly and XLogReceiptTime isn't |
| * changed. |
| * |
| * NB: We must set readTimeLineHistory based on |
| * recoveryTargetTLI, not receiveTLI. Normally they'll |
| * be the same, but if recovery_target_timeline is |
| * 'latest' and archiving is configured, then it's |
| * possible that we managed to retrieve one or more |
| * new timeline history files from the archive, |
| * updating recoveryTargetTLI. |
| */ |
| if (readFile < 0) |
| { |
| if (!expectedTLEs) |
| expectedTLEs = readTimeLineHistory(recoveryTargetTLI); |
| readFile = XLogFileRead(readSegNo, PANIC, |
| receiveTLI, |
| XLOG_FROM_STREAM, false); |
| Assert(readFile >= 0); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* just make sure source info is correct... */ |
| readSource = XLOG_FROM_STREAM; |
| XLogReceiptSource = XLOG_FROM_STREAM; |
| return true; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Data not here yet. Check for trigger, then wait for |
| * walreceiver to wake us up when new WAL arrives. |
| */ |
| if (CheckForStandbyTrigger()) |
| { |
| elogif(debug_xlog_record_read, LOG, |
| "xlog page read -- Standby trigger was activated"); |
| /* |
| * Note that we don't "return false" immediately here. |
| * After being triggered, we still want to replay all |
| * the WAL that was already streamed. It's in pg_wal |
| * now, so we just treat this as a failure, and the |
| * state machine will move on to replay the streamed |
| * WAL from pg_wal, and then recheck the trigger and |
| * exit replay. |
| */ |
| lastSourceFailed = true; |
| break; |
| } |
| elogif(debug_xlog_record_read, LOG, |
| "xlog page read -- No xlog data to read as of now. " |
| "Will Wait on latch till some event occurs"); |
| |
| /* |
| * Since we have replayed everything we have received so |
| * far and are about to start waiting for more WAL, let's |
| * tell the upstream server our replay location now so |
| * that pg_stat_replication doesn't show stale |
| * information. |
| */ |
| if (!streaming_reply_sent) |
| { |
| WalRcvForceReply(); |
| streaming_reply_sent = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Wait for more WAL to arrive. Time out after 5 seconds |
| * to react to a trigger file promptly and to check if the |
| * WAL receiver is still active. |
| */ |
| (void) WaitLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch, |
| WL_LATCH_SET | WL_TIMEOUT | |
| WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH, |
| 5000L, WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_WAL_STREAM); |
| ResetLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| default: |
| elog(ERROR, "unexpected WAL source %d", currentSource); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check for recovery pause here so that we can confirm more quickly |
| * that a requested pause has actually taken effect. |
| */ |
| if (((volatile XLogCtlData *) XLogCtl)->recoveryPauseState != |
| RECOVERY_NOT_PAUSED) |
| recoveryPausesHere(false); |
| |
| /* |
| * This possibly-long loop needs to handle interrupts of startup |
| * process. |
| */ |
| HandleStartupProcInterrupts(); |
| } |
| |
| return false; /* not reached */ |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Set flag to signal the walreceiver to restart. (The startup process calls |
| * this on noticing a relevant configuration change.) |
| */ |
| void |
| StartupRequestWalReceiverRestart(void) |
| { |
| if (currentSource == XLOG_FROM_STREAM && WalRcvRunning()) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("WAL receiver process shutdown requested"))); |
| |
| pendingWalRcvRestart = true; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Determine what log level should be used to report a corrupt WAL record |
| * in the current WAL page, previously read by XLogPageRead(). |
| * |
| * 'emode' is the error mode that would be used to report a file-not-found |
| * or legitimate end-of-WAL situation. Generally, we use it as-is, but if |
| * we're retrying the exact same record that we've tried previously, only |
| * complain the first time to keep the noise down. However, we only do when |
| * reading from pg_wal, because we don't expect any invalid records in archive |
| * or in records streamed from the primary. Files in the archive should be complete, |
| * and we should never hit the end of WAL because we stop and wait for more WAL |
| * to arrive before replaying it. |
| * |
| * NOTE: This function remembers the RecPtr value it was last called with, |
| * to suppress repeated messages about the same record. Only call this when |
| * you are about to ereport(), or you might cause a later message to be |
| * erroneously suppressed. |
| */ |
| static int |
| emode_for_corrupt_record(int emode, XLogRecPtr RecPtr) |
| { |
| static XLogRecPtr lastComplaint = 0; |
| |
| if (readSource == XLOG_FROM_PG_WAL && emode == LOG) |
| { |
| if (RecPtr == lastComplaint) |
| emode = DEBUG1; |
| else |
| lastComplaint = RecPtr; |
| } |
| return emode; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Has a standby promotion already been triggered? |
| * |
| * Unlike CheckForStandbyTrigger(), this works in any process |
| * that's connected to shared memory. |
| */ |
| bool |
| PromoteIsTriggered(void) |
| { |
| /* |
| * We check shared state each time only until a standby promotion is |
| * triggered. We can't trigger a promotion again, so there's no need to |
| * keep checking after the shared variable has once been seen true. |
| */ |
| if (LocalPromoteIsTriggered) |
| return true; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| LocalPromoteIsTriggered = XLogCtl->SharedPromoteIsTriggered; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| return LocalPromoteIsTriggered; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| SetPromoteIsTriggered(void) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->SharedPromoteIsTriggered = true; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * Mark the recovery pause state as 'not paused' because the paused state |
| * ends and promotion continues if a promotion is triggered while recovery |
| * is paused. Otherwise pg_get_wal_replay_pause_state() can mistakenly |
| * return 'paused' while a promotion is ongoing. |
| */ |
| SetRecoveryPause(false); |
| |
| LocalPromoteIsTriggered = true; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check to see whether the user-specified trigger file exists and whether a |
| * promote request has arrived. If either condition holds, return true. |
| */ |
| static bool |
| CheckForStandbyTrigger(void) |
| { |
| struct stat stat_buf; |
| |
| if (LocalPromoteIsTriggered) |
| return true; |
| |
| if (IsPromoteSignaled() && CheckPromoteSignal()) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, (errmsg("received promote request"))); |
| RemovePromoteSignalFiles(); |
| ResetPromoteSignaled(); |
| SetPromoteIsTriggered(); |
| return true; |
| } |
| |
| if (PromoteTriggerFile == NULL || strcmp(PromoteTriggerFile, "") == 0) |
| return false; |
| |
| if (stat(PromoteTriggerFile, &stat_buf) == 0) |
| { |
| ereport(LOG, |
| (errmsg("promote trigger file found: %s", PromoteTriggerFile))); |
| unlink(PromoteTriggerFile); |
| SetPromoteIsTriggered(); |
| return true; |
| } |
| else if (errno != ENOENT) |
| ereport(ERROR, |
| (errcode_for_file_access(), |
| errmsg("could not stat promote trigger file \"%s\": %m", |
| PromoteTriggerFile))); |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Remove the files signaling a standby promotion request. |
| */ |
| void |
| RemovePromoteSignalFiles(void) |
| { |
| unlink(PROMOTE_SIGNAL_FILE); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check to see if a promote request has arrived. |
| */ |
| bool |
| CheckPromoteSignal(void) |
| { |
| struct stat stat_buf; |
| |
| if (stat(PROMOTE_SIGNAL_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0) |
| return true; |
| |
| return false; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Wake up startup process to replay newly arrived WAL, or to notice that |
| * failover has been requested. |
| */ |
| void |
| WakeupRecovery(void) |
| { |
| SetLatch(&XLogCtl->recoveryWakeupLatch); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Update the WalWriterSleeping flag. |
| */ |
| void |
| SetWalWriterSleeping(bool sleeping) |
| { |
| SpinLockAcquire(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = sleeping; |
| SpinLockRelease(&XLogCtl->info_lck); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * True if we are currently performing crash recovery. |
| * False if we are running standby-mode continuous or archive recovery. |
| */ |
| bool |
| IsCrashRecoveryOnly(void) |
| { |
| return !ArchiveRecoveryRequested && !StandbyModeRequested; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Report the last WAL replay location |
| */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| last_xlog_replay_location() |
| { |
| /* use volatile pointer to prevent code rearrangement */ |
| volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl; |
| Assert(xlogctl != NULL); |
| XLogRecPtr recptr; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&xlogctl->info_lck); |
| recptr = xlogctl->lastReplayedEndRecPtr; |
| SpinLockRelease(&xlogctl->info_lck); |
| |
| return recptr; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| initialize_wal_bytes_written(void) |
| { |
| wal_bytes_written = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Transactions on commit, wait for replication and make sure WAL is flushed |
| * up to commit lsn on mirror in GPDB. While commit is mandatory sync/wait |
| * point, waiting for replication at some periodic intervals even before that |
| * may be desirable/efficient to act as good citizen in system. Consider for |
| * example setup where primary and mirror can write at 20GB/sec, while network |
| * between them can only transfer at 2GB/sec. Now if CTAS is run in such setup |
| * for large table, it can generate WAL very aggressively on primary, but |
| * can't be transfered at that rate to mirror. Hence, there would be pending |
| * WAL build-up on primary. This exhibits two main things: |
| * |
| * - new write transactions (even if single tuple I/U/D), would exhibit |
| * latency for amount of time equivalent to the pending WAL to be shipped and |
| * flushed to mirror |
| * |
| * - primary needs to have space to hold that much WAL, since till the WAL is |
| * not shipped to mirror, it can't be recycled |
| * |
| * So, to make the situation better instead of waiting for mirror only at |
| * commit point, waiting for mirror in-between transaction after writing N |
| * bytes of WAL will help avoid the situation. This function checks if |
| * transaction has written above rep_lag_avoidance_threshold bytes, and waits |
| * for mirror if that's the case. This function can be called to avoid bulk |
| * transactions starving concurrent transactions from commiting due to sync |
| * rep. This interface provides a way for primary to avoid racing forward with |
| * WAL generation and move at sustained speed with network and mirrors. |
| * |
| * NB: This function should never be called from inside a critical section, |
| * meaning caller should never have MyProc->delayChkpt set to true. Otherwise, |
| * if mirror is down, we will end up in a deadlock situation between the primary |
| * and the checkpointer process, because if MyProc->delayChkpt is set, |
| * checkpointer cannot proceed to unset WalSndCtl->sync_standbys_defined. |
| */ |
| void |
| wait_to_avoid_large_repl_lag(void) |
| { |
| Assert(!MyProc->delayChkpt); |
| /* rep_lag_avoidance_threshold is defined in KB */ |
| if (rep_lag_avoidance_threshold && |
| wal_bytes_written > (rep_lag_avoidance_threshold * 1024)) |
| { |
| /* we use local cached copy of LogwrtResult here */ |
| /* |
| * SyncRepWaitForLSN assumes that the caller has hold interrupts. It's |
| * not obvious because calling HOLD_INTERRUPTS() doesn't appears near |
| * SyncRepWaitForLSN(). Enabling interrupts may cause some issues. |
| * |
| * See more details: |
| * https://github.com/postgres/postgres/commit/e174f699c476a4cc01875211a5f43e57c3190a37 |
| * https://www.postgresql.org/message-id/flat/a0806273-8bbb-43b3-bbe1-c45a58f6ae21.lingce.ldm%40alibaba-inc.com |
| */ |
| HOLD_INTERRUPTS(); |
| SyncRepWaitForLSN(LogwrtResult.Flush, false); |
| RESUME_INTERRUPTS(); |
| wal_bytes_written = 0; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| wait_for_mirror() |
| { |
| XLogwrtResult tmpLogwrtResult; |
| /* use volatile pointer to prevent code rearrangement */ |
| volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl; |
| |
| SpinLockAcquire(&xlogctl->info_lck); |
| tmpLogwrtResult = xlogctl->LogwrtResult; |
| SpinLockRelease(&xlogctl->info_lck); |
| |
| /* |
| * SyncRepWaitForLSN assumes that the caller has hold interrupts. It's |
| * not obvious because calling HOLD_INTERRUPTS() doesn't appears near |
| * SyncRepWaitForLSN(). Enabling interrupts may cause some issues. |
| * |
| * See more details: |
| * https://github.com/postgres/postgres/commit/e174f699c476a4cc01875211a5f43e57c3190a37 |
| * https://www.postgresql.org/message-id/flat/a0806273-8bbb-43b3-bbe1-c45a58f6ae21.lingce.ldm%40alibaba-inc.com |
| */ |
| HOLD_INTERRUPTS(); |
| SyncRepWaitForLSN(tmpLogwrtResult.Flush, false); |
| RESUME_INTERRUPTS(); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Check to see if we're a mirror, and if we are: (1) Assume that we are |
| * running as superuser; (2) No data pages need to be accessed by this backend |
| * - no snapshot / transaction needed. |
| * |
| * The recovery.conf file is renamed to recovery.done at the end of xlog |
| * replay. Normal backends can be created thereafter. |
| */ |
| bool |
| IsRoleMirror() |
| { |
| struct stat stat_buf; |
| return (stat(STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, &stat_buf) == 0); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * GPDB_90_MERGE_FIXME: This function should be removed once hot |
| * standby can and will be enabled for mirrors. |
| */ |
| void SignalPromote(void) |
| { |
| FILE *fd; |
| if ((fd = fopen(PROMOTE_SIGNAL_FILE, "w"))) |
| { |
| fclose(fd); |
| kill(PostmasterPid, SIGUSR1); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* GPDB: Used for twophase global transaction */ |
| XLogRecPtr |
| XLogLastInsertBeginLoc(void) |
| { |
| return ProcLastRecPtr; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Schedule a walreceiver wakeup in the main recovery loop. |
| */ |
| void |
| XLogRequestWalReceiverReply(void) |
| { |
| doRequestWalReceiverReply = true; |
| } |